Home

User Manual - FTP Directory Listing

image

Contents

1. ceeee 174 Chapter 9 Use the Modem Router as a Media Server Specify ReadyDLNA Media Server SettingS cccccccsssssseeeeeeeeesesseesneeeeeees 177 Rescan the Media Files for Content scccccccceeesseeeneceeeeeeessssensnaeeeeeeeeseees 177 Play Music From a Storage Device With iTunes Servel ccceeeesseeeeeeeeeeeees 178 Play Media From a USB Device on TiVoO uesseesseseserreresrrerirsrrinsrrrserirsnnnsa 180 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up the Modem Router to Work With TiV0 eccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeees 180 Play OG ga cas ss ieri inaire ic EAEra sees eas eee ET aE Eii aes 181 Play Music or View PMOtOGicccccssssecaceasssieccdecianeeeatecsatarnnentdenncansinacaeeuees 181 Copy TiVo Files to a COMpULGr 22 6e3 24ccitese etter 181 Chapter 10 Share a USB Printer Install the Printer Driver and Cable the Printer ssessseesesenesssrnneerrrnesrerresene 183 Download the ReadySHARE Printer Utility eeenneeeeennneeeeenenesernnnerenreesreresene 183 Install the ReadySHARE Printer Utility 2 ecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeee 183 Use the Shared PrIM ciir nee RE ER ERA AE EE 186 Manually Connect and Print sseeessenessseresseenneeeneressrrnnstrtnntrrnnntnsrnrnsserrn nnt 186 Print and Release the Printer ccsccecesssseeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeessaaeeeeneaas 186 View or Change the Status of a Printer
2. Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No Internet Service Provider PPPoE Login guest Password Service Name If Required Connection Mode Always On X Idie Timeout In Minutes 5 Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address 0 0 0 0 Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address 20 63 91 7a 14 99 11 Enter the ADSL settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 56 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee bea o Multiplexing Method Select LLC BASED or VC BASED as indicated by your ISP The multiplexing method can either be virtual circuit VC based or logical link control LLC based VPI Enter a number between 0 and 255 for the virtual circuit number for the virtual path identifier VPI as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VPI setting leave the default setting 8 The VPI might be required not only for a VC based connection but also for an LLC based connection VCI Enter a number between 32 and 65535 for the virtual circuit number for the virtual channel identifier VCI as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VCI setting leave the default setting 35 The VCI might be requ
3. To view or specify the settings for an ADSL Internet connection that does not require a login 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Internet Settings Manually 50 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select Internet The Internet Setup page displays From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out 6 From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other From the Transfer Mode menu select ADSL ATM From the DSL Mode menu select the ADSL mode that your ISP provided you Auto The modem router detects the DSL mode automatically This is the default setting ADSL Legacy version of ADSL ADSL2 Legacy version of ADSL2 ADSL2 ADSL2 provides the fastest downstream rates and can interoperate with ADSL2 and ADSL Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected Note For some ISPs you can select the IPTV virtual interface from the menu above the Enable
4. Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 204 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manage the Modem Router s LAN IP Address Settings The modem router is preconfigured to use private IP addresses on the LAN side and to act as a DHCP server The modem router s default LAN IP configuration is as follows LAN IP address 192 168 1 1 This is the same as www routerlogin net and www routerlogin com Subnet mask 255 255 255 0 These addresses are part of the designated private address range for use in private networks and are suitable for most applications The IP address and subnet mask identify which addresses are local to a specific device and which must be reached through a gateway or modem router You might want to change these settings if you need a specific IP subnet that one or more devices on the network use or if competing subnets use the same IP scheme To change the LAN IP address settings i 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup LAN Setup CCD H Device Name oroo CD LAN TCP IP Setup IP Address 192 168 j1 sta IP Subnet Mask 255 255 1 255 1 0 RIP Directi
5. The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering Port Forwarding Port Triggering Please select the service type Port Forwarding 2 Port Triggering Service Name Server IP Address FIP ri 192 168 1 s Add ServiceName External Start Port External End Port Internal Start Port Internal End Port Internal IP address 1 IP_Phone 6670 6670 6670 6670 192 168 1 15 2 Quakellii 27960 27960 27960 27960 192 168 1 213 f Edit Service x Delete Service Add Custom Service The previous figure shows two custom port forwarding rules Make sure that the Port Forwarding radio button is selected In the table select the radio button next to the service or application name Click the Delete Service button The rule is removed from the table Application Example Make a Local Web Server Public If you host a web server on your local network you can use port forwarding to allow web requests from anyone on the Internet to reach your web server Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 272 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To make a local web server public 1 Assign your web server either a fixed IP address or a dynamic IP address using DHCP address reservation In this example your router always gives your web server an IP address of 192 168 1 33 2 On the Port Forwarding Port Triggering page configure the modem router to forwar
6. This process erases all settings that you configured in the modem router To reset the modem router to factory default settings 1 On the back of the modem router locate the Reset button to the right of the leftmost antenna Using a straightened paper clip press and hold the Reset button for at least five seconds Release the Reset button The Power LED starts blinking amber and the configuration is reset to factory default settings When the reset is complete the modem router reboots This process takes about two minutes WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the reset For example if you are connected to the modem router s web page do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white Erase the Settings AN CAUTION This process erases all settings that you configured in the modem router Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 222 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To erase the settings f 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home pa
7. e To log in as admin in the user name field enter admin and in the password field enter the same password that you use to log in to the modem router e To log in as guest in the user name field enter guest The guest user name does not need a password The files and folders that your account can access on the USB device display For example you might see share partitionl directoryl Navigate to a location on the USB device Download or upload the file Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 175 Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 9 The modem router comes set up to work as a ReadyDLNA media server You can set up the modem router to play music from iTunes Server and media from TiVo This chapter contains the following sections e Specify ReadyDLNA Media Server Settings on page 177 e Rescan the Media Files for Content on page 177 e Play Music From a Storage Device With iTunes Server on page 178 e Play Media From a USB Device on TiVo on page 180 176 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Specify ReadyDLNA Media Server Settings By default the modem router functions as a ReadyDLNA media server which lets you view movies and photos on DLNA UPnP AV compliant media players such as Xbox360 Playstation and NETGEAR media players To specify media server settings i 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network
8. Internet connection WAN MAC address Use default hardware address WAN MTU size Determined by the protocol that is used for the Internet connection see MTU Concepts on page 93 b DHCP starting IP address 192 168 1 2 DHCP ending IP address 192 168 1 254 DMZ Disabled North America Pacific Standard Time Time zone Europe GMT Other continents Varies by region Supplemental Information 295 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 sled Time adjusted for daylight saving time Disabled North America United States Country region Europe Europe Other continents Varies by region RF channel Auto The available channels depend on the region Transmission speed Note Throughput can vary Network conditions and environmental factors including volume of network traffic building materials and construction and network overhead affect the data throughput rate e Up to 800 Mbps at 2 4 GHz Operating mode e Up to 1733 Mbps at 5 GHz Transmit power 100 Guest WiFi network SSID name 2 4 GHz band NETGEAR Guest e 5 GHz band NETGEAR 5G Guest Allow guests to access main network Disabled Supplemental Information 296 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 General WiFi settings Radio transmission power 20 40 MHz coexistence Fragmentation length CTS RTS threshold Preamble mode Enabled see the modem router web pages select ADVANCED gt Adv
9. Login guest Password Service Name If Required Connection Mode Always On Idle Timeout in Minutes 5 Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address 0 0 0 0 Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address a0 63 91 7a 14 99 10 Enter the VDSL settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 65 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Description Multiplexing Method These settings are disabled because they do not apply to a VDSL connection Use VLANID Select the Use VLANID check box and enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP AVLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting Priority 0 7 If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 VP VC You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 Internet Service Provider By default the menu selection is PPPoE for a PPP over Ethernet VDSL connection The VDSL connection does not supp
10. Recover the admin Password on page 221 Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default Settings on page 221 e Disable LED Blinking or Turn Off LEDs on page 223 e View the Status and Statistics of the Modem Router on page 224 e View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 e Manage the Activity Log on page 235 e Monitor and Meter Internet Traffic on page 237 e Manage the Modem Router Remotely on page 243 Note For information about changing the admin password see Change the admin Password on page 40 For information about setting up password recovery see Set Up Password Recovery on page 41 216 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Update the Firmware of the Modem Router The modem router firmware is stored in flash memory You can check to see if new firmware is available and update the modem router to the new firmware You can also visit the NETGEAR support website download the firmware manually and update the modem router to the new firmware Check for New Firmware and Update the Modem Router For you to check for new firmware the modem router must be connected to the Internet To check for new firmware and update your modem router 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is pas
11. Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the No radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 69 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure a cable or fiber connection without a login Internet Setup ED CHIC GED Select Country USA Select Internet Service Provider Other KA Internet Y Enable This Interface Use VLANID Priority 0 7 0 Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No m Account Name If Required D7800 Domain Name If Required Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address 0 0 L10 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 0 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Use IP Over ATM IPoA IP Address 0 0 0 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 0 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Third DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address a0 63 91 7a 14 99 DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option 60 Client Identifier String option 61 12 Enter the cable or fiber settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 70 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ns Use VLANID Select the Use VLANID check box and
12. WPA2 PSK AES security To use WPA2 security in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES This type of security enables WiFi devices that support either WPA or WPA2 to join the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network However WPA PSK TKIP is less secure than WPA2 PSK AES and limits the speed of WiFi devices to 54 Mbps To use WPA WPA2 security in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA WPA2 Enterprise This type of security requires that your WiFi network can access a RADIUS server For information about configuring WPA WPA2 Enterprise see Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiFi Security on page 104 Passphrase The passphrase that provides users access to the guest WiFi network in the 2 4 GHZ band The passphrase is also referred to as the password or key Wireless Network 5GHz 802 11a n ac Enable Guest Network By default the guest WiFi network is disabled To enable the guest WiFi network for the 5 GHz WiFi band select the Enable Guest Network check box Enable SSID Broadcast By default the modem router broadcasts its SSID of the 5 GHz WiFi band so that WiFi stations can detect the WiFi name SSID in their scanned network lists To turn off the SSID broadcast for the 5 GHz WiFi ba
13. e Always On Once the Internet connection is established it remains active This is the default setting Dial on Demand When someone attempts to connect to the Internet the Internet connection is established When the idle time out period expires the Internet connection is terminated Manually Connect You must connect to the Internet manually see View Establish or Terminate the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet Connection on page 232 Idle Timeout In Minutes If you select Dial on Demand from the Connection Mode menu enter the idle time out period in minutes The idle time out specifies how long the modem router keeps the Internet connection active when no one on the network is using the Internet connection The default is 5 minutes To disable the idle time out enter 0 When you disable the idle time out the connection is not terminated automatically Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Use Static IP Address Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address Us
14. Access Storage Devices From a Remote Computer You can access storage devices that are attached to your modem router from a remote computer To access devices from a remote computer 1 Launch a web browser on a computer that is not on your home network 2 Connect to your modem router on your home network e To connect with Dynamic DNS type the DNS name To use a Dynamic DNS account you must enter the account information on the Dynamic DNS page see Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS on page 168 e To connect without Dynamic DNS type the modem router s Internet port IP address You can view the modem router s Internet IP address on the BASIC Home page Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 172 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up FTP Access Through the Internet If you attach a storage device to the modem router you can access the storage device from your network see Enable FTP Access Within Your Network on page 157 You can also set up FTP access through the Internet so that you can access the storage device from outside your local network for example when you are not at home t To set up FTP access through the Internet 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net The login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default pas
15. Does the WiFi device that you are using find your WiFi network If not check the WiFi LED on the top of the modem router If this LED is off both WiFi radios might be disabled For more information about the WiFi radios see Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 If you disabled the modem router s SSID broadcast your WiFi network is hidden and does not display in your WiFi client s scanning list By default SSID broadcast is enabled For more information see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 Does your WiFi device support the security that you are using for your WiFi network WEP WPA or WPA2 For information about changing the WiFi security see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 Tip If you want to change the WiFi settings of the modem router s main network use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when the new WiFi settings take effect If your WiFi device finds your network but the signal strength is weak check these conditions Is your modem router too far from your WiFi device or too close Place your WiFi device near the modem router but at least 6 feet 1 8 meters away and see whether the signal strength improves Are objects between the modem router and your WiFi device blocking the WiFi signal Troubleshoot Your Network Using the Ping Utility Most network devices and routers contain a ping utility that sends an echo request packet to the designated device The device then re
16. Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Media Server The Media Server Settings page displays Specify the settings Enable Media Server Select this check box to enable this device to function as a media server Enable TiVo support Select this check box if you want to play USB or ReadyNAS media on your TiVo device See Play Media From a USB Device on TiVo on page 180 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved To change the name of the media server click the Edit button The LAN Setup page displays In the Device Name field type a new device name for the modem router By default the device name is D7800 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Rescan the Media Files for Content When new media files are added the modem router scans for content automatically You can also rescan the media files for content Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 177 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To rescan the media files for content 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user na
17. Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays Manage the Internet Settings Manually 94 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Inthe MTU Size field enter a value from 616 to 1500 The normal MTU maximum transmit unit value for most Ethernet networks is 1500 bytes 1492 bytes for PPPoE connections or 1436 for PPTP connections 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the Internet Settings Manually 95 Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 4 This chapter describes how you can manage the basic WiFi network settings of the modem router For information about the advanced WiFi settings see Manage the Advanced WiFi Features on page 246 The chapter includes the following sections e Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network on page 97 e Use WPS to Add a Device to the WiFi Network on page 108 e Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Guest Network on page 110 e Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 For information about setting up an access control list ACL and managing WiFi access for enhanced security see Manage Network Access Control Lists on page 121 96 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800
18. My mail server requires authentication If your outgoing email server requires authentication select this check box and specify the following settings e Inthe User Name field enter the user name for the outgoing email server In the Password field enter the password for the outgoing email server Send Alert Immediately Control Access to the Internet 137 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Send Alert Immediately Select this check box to enable the modem router to send an email alert immediately when someone attempts to visit a blocked site When someone attempts to visit a blocked site Send logs according to this schedule To send logs based on a schedule select one of the following options from the menu When log is full This is the default selection Hourly Logs are sent every hour Daily Logs are sent every day From the Time menu specify the time of day and select the am or pm radio button Weekly Logs are sent every week From the Day menu select the day From the Time menu specify the time of day and select the am or pm radio button If you do not want logs to be sent at all select None from the menu 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Logs are sent automatically If the log fills before the specified time it is sent After the log is sent it is cleared from the modem router memory If the modem router cannot email the log and the log buffer fil
19. The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 87 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The IPv6 page displays From the Internet Connection Type menu select DHCP Pv E LID EE EED Internet Connection Type DHCP X User Class if Required Domain Name If Required Router s IPv6 Address On WAN Not Available LAN Setup Router s IPv6 Address On LAN Not Available IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config Use This Interface ID 0 0 0 IPv6 Filtering Secured Open The modem router automatically detects the information in the following fields e Router s IPv6 Address On WAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s WAN or Internet interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available e Router s IPv6 Address On LAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s LAN interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available If your IPv6 ISP gave you a specific host name in the User Class If Required field enter the host name If your IPv6 ISP did not g
20. The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Media Server Media Server Settings V Enable Media Server v Enable TiVo support Enable iTunes Server Music Only Enter Passcode displayed on the Remote App Allow Control Apply gt Content Scan Automatic when new files added Rescan media files Select the Enable iTunes Media Server Music Only check box If the Enter Passcode displayed on the Remote App field is masked click the Apply button Enter the passcode Click the Allow Control button Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 179 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 On your iPhone or iPad the ReadySHARE music library displays in the remote app You can play this music on AirPlay devices Play Media From a USB Device on TiVo You can set up your TiVo to access media files stored on a USB device that is connected to your modem router The TiVo must be on the same network as the modem router This feature supports the following file formats e Video See and play MPEG1 and MPEG2 files e Music See and play MP3 files e Pictures View images in Jpc format You can use the TiVo Series 2 and up Home Media Option to play photos and music on your Windows or Mac computer in your TiVo user interface Set Up the Modem Router to Work With TiVo To set up the modem router to work with TiVo 1 Laun
21. WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the upload For example do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white A progress bar shows the progress of the firmware upload process The firmware upload process takes several minutes When the upload is complete your modem router restarts Verify that the modem router runs the new firmware version a Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network b Enter http Awww routerlogin net A login window opens c Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays The version firmware is stated in the top right under the Logout button Manage the Configuration File of the Modem Router The configuration settings of the modem router are stored within the modem router in a configuration file You can back up save this file to your computer or restore it Back Up the Settings You can save a copy of the current configuration settings To back up the modem router s configuration settings 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem ro
22. a From the Please choose a wireless network menu select the WiFi band that the other modem router is using For 802 11ac mode both modem routers must use the 5 GHz band b Inthe Name SSID field enter the WiFi network name SSID that the other modem router is using Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 255 9 10 11 12 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In the previous figure the SSID name NETGEAR Bridge is just an example c Inthe Security Options section select the radio button for the WiFi security that the other modem router is using d If prompted type the passphrase the WiFi password that you must use to connect with WiFi to the other modem router Click the Apply button Your settings are saved To let the modem router that functions as the WiFi bridge get an IP address dynamically from the modem router that is connected to the Internet modem leave the Get dynamically from existing router radio button selected We recommend that you leave the Get dynamically from existing router radio button selected However if you are sure that must use a static IP address you can specify a static IP address from your other router s LAN IP address pool To specify static IP address for the modem router that functions as the WiFi bridge do the following a Select the Use fixed IP Address not recommended radio button A pop up window opens b Enter all static IP addresses
23. e Are you using the correct network name SSID and password Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiFi Security Remote Authentication Dial In User Service RADIUS is an enterprise level method for centralized Authentication Authorization and Accounting AAA management To provide WPA WPA2 enterprise WiFi security the WiFi network that the modem router provides must be able to access a RADIUS server Tip If you want to change the WiFi settings of the modem router s main network use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when the new WiFi settings take effect To configure WPA WPA2 enterprise security 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http Awww routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Wireless The Wireless Settings page displays Note If you are configuring a guest network select Guest Network instead The Guest Network Settings page displays Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 104 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Inthe Security Options section below either the Wireless Network 2 4GHz b g n section or the Wireless Network 5GHz 802 1 1a n ac section select the WPA WPA2 Enterprise radio button Security Options None WEP
24. www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays Clear the Disable IGMP Proxying check box By default the Disable IGMP Proxying check box is selected and IGMP proxying is disabled Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage NAT Filtering Network Address Translation NAT determines how the modem router processes inbound traffic Secured NAT protects computers on the LAN from attacks from the Internet but might prevent some Internet games point to point applications or multimedia applications from working Open NAT provides a much less secured firewall but allows almost all Internet applications to work Secured NAT is the default setting To change the default NAT filtering settings 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 203 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN S
25. Block all new devices from connecting With this setting if you add a new device before it can access your network you must enter its MAC address for an Ethernet connection and its MAC address for a WiFi connection in the allowed list For more information see Manage Network Access Control Lists on page 121 The access rule does not affect previously blocked or allowed devices It applies only to devices joining your network in the future after you apply these settings 8 To manage access for currently connected computers and devices do the following e If you blocked all new devices from connecting to allow the computer or device that you are currently using to continue to access the network select the check box next to your computer or WiFi device in the table and click the Allow button Control Access to the Internet 120 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e To either continue to allow or to block other computers and devices that are currently connected select the check box next to the computer or device in the table and click either the Allow button or the Block button Access Control CID EL You can use Access Control to allow or block computers or electronic devices from accessing your network Turn on Access Control Access Rule This is a general rule You can also allow or block individual devices Allow all new devices to connect Block all new devices from connecting iE
26. Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Internet The Internet Setup page displays 5 From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out 6 From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 7 From the Transfer Mode menu select VDSL PTM When you select VDSL PTM from the Transfer Mode menu the only option in the DSL Mode menu is VDSL2 Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the Yes radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 64 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure a VDSL connection with a login and PPPoE service Internet Setup Select Country USA Select Internet Service Provider Other X Transfer Mode VDSL PTM DSL Mode VDSL2 Internet V Enable This Interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED VPI 8 vel 35 Use VLANID Priority 0 7 Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No Internet Service Provider PPPoE
27. The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Access Control Access Control ECTE LEE You can use Access Control to allow or block computers or electronic devices from accessing your network Turn on Access Control Access Rule This is a general rule You can also allow or block individual devices Allow all new devices to connect Block all new devices from connecting Allow Block Edit Refresh MM Status Device Name IP Address MAC Address Connection Type Allowed BUSINESSLAPTOP 192 168 1 2 60 66 66 DA 66 7C Wireless NETGEARS84 Allowed ANDROID 192 168 1 3 C0 D1 D1 B0 F0 D1 Wireless NETGEAR84 5G gt View list of allowed devices not currently connected to the network gt View list of blocked devices not currently connected to the network The previous figure shows two WiFi devices connected 5 Select the Turn on Access Control check box You must select this check box before you can specify an access rule and use the Allow and Block buttons When the Turn on Access Control check box is cleared all devices are allowed to connect even if a device is in the list of blocked devices 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 7 Select an access rule for new devices Allow all new devices to connect With this setting if you add a new device it can access your network You do not need to enter its MAC address on this page We recommend that you leave this radio button selected
28. The wireless signal is scheduled to turn off during the following time period Perioa Start ena Recurrence patem Add a new period Edit Delete Click the Add a new period button Advanced Wireless Settings CH EED When to turn off wireless signal Start 12 00 midnight X End 12 00 midnight X Recurrence Pattern Daily Select Days Sunday Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Use the menus radio buttons and check boxes to set up a period during which you want to turn off the WiFi signal and specify whether the schedule is recurrent Click the Apply button The Advanced Wireless Settings page displays Select the Turn off wireless signal by schedule check box to activate the schedule Click the Apply button Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 248 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Your settings are saved Manage the WPS Settings Wi Fi Protected Setup WPS lets you join the WiFi network without typing the WiFi password You can change the WPS default settings To manage WPS settings 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Ad
29. This Interface check box If you are specifying the settings for the IPTV virtual interface select IPTV from the menu However first specify the settings for the Internet virtual interface which is the default interface before you specify the settings for the IPTV virtual interface 10 Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the No radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 51 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure an ADSL connection without a login Internet Setup Select Country USA jE Select Internet Service Provider Other id Transfer Mode ADSL ATM DSL Mode Auto S Internet m7 V Enable This Interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED v VPI o vel 32 Euse VLANID Priority 0 7 o Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No Account Name If Required D7800 Domain Name If Required Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address 0 0 0 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 0 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Use IP Over ATM IPoA IP Address 0 0 0 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 L10 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary ONS Third DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address
30. in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA WPA2 Enterprise This type of security requires that your WiFi network can access a RADIUS server For information about configuring WPA WPA2 Enterprise see Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiFi Security on page 104 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved If you connected over WiFi to the network and you changed the SSID you are disconnected from the network Make sure that you can reconnect over WiFi to the network with its new settings If you cannot connect over WiFi check the following e If your computer or WiFi device is already connected to another WiFi network in your area disconnect it from that WiFi network and connect it to the WiFi network that the modem router provides Some WiFi devices automatically connect to the first open network without WiFi security that they discover e lf your computer or WiFi device is trying to connect to your network with its old settings before you changed the settings update the WiFi network selection in your computer or WiFi device to match the current settings for your network e Does your WiFi device display as an attached device See View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 If it does it is connected to the network Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 103 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800
31. recommended PIN Number This is the security PIN of the WPS client While connecting WPS enablied adapters provide a randomly generated security PIN Enter Client s PIN In the Enter Clients PIN field enter the PIN number of the WiFi device Click the Next button For four minutes the modem router attempts to find the WiFi device that is the client that you want to join the modem router s main WiFi network During this time the WiFi LED on the top panel of the modem router blinks white 9 Within four minutes go to the WiFi device and use its WPS software to join the network without entering a password When the modem router establishes a WPS connection the WiFi LED lights solid white and the Add WPS Client page displays a confirmation message 10 To verify that the WiFi device is connected to the modem router s main WiFi network select BASIC gt Attached Devices The WiFi device displays onscreen Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Guest Network A guest network allows visitors to use the Internet without using your WiFi security key By default the guest WiFi network is disabled You can enable and configure the guest WiFi network for each WiFi band The modem router Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 110 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 simultaneously supports the 2 4 GHz band for 802 11n 802 119 and 802 11b devices and the 5 GHz band for 802
32. www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Internet The Internet Setup page displays When you set up your Internet connection either through NETGEAR genie through the Setup Wizard or manually the country ISP transfer mode and DSL mode were already specified Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 193 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 From the menu above the Enable This Interface check box select IPTV Internet Setup GED OCZ GEL Select Country Germany r Select Internet Service Provider Deutsche Telekom v Transfer Mode VDSL PTM v DSL Mode VDSL2 v IPTV X Enable This Interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED VPI VCI Use VLANID 8 Priority 0 7 o V Bridge Mode If select Bridge Mode the LAN4 port will be configured as IPTV portyou can select max 3 LAN ports for 3 IPTV devices to connect to LAN1 is reserved for wired internet V Enable IPTV on LAN4 L Enable IPTV on LAN3 Enable IPTV on LAN2 6 Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected for the virtual IPTV interface If you already enabled and configured the virtual IPTV interface the check box is selected 7 Select the Bridge Mode check box By default the LAN 4 port is bound to the virtual IPTV
33. 11ac 802 11n and 802 11a devices The WiFi mode of the guest WiFi network depends on the WiFi mode of the main WiFi network For example if you configure the WiFi mode for the main WiFi network as Up to 54 Mbps in the 2 4 GHz band the guest WiFi network also functions in the Up to 54 Mbps mode in the 2 4 GHz band For information about configuring the WiFi mode see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 The modem router provides two default guest networks with the following names SSIDs e 2 4 GHz band NETGEAR Guest 5 GHz band NETGEAR 5G Guest By default these networks are configured as open networks without security but are disabled You can enable one or both networks You can also change the SSIDs for these networks To set up a guest network 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 111 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select Guest Network ECB EMD Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n Enable Guest Network v Enable SSID Broadcast Allow guests to see each other and access my local network Guest Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR Guest Securit
34. 2 Music 4 Network Infrastructure 2 5 Pictures B Videos wei WNDR4500 Gateway wi 07800 Gateway 4 amp Computer amp Windows7_OS C Removable Disk D Lenovo Recovery Q The network resources display The ReadySHARE icon is inthe Computer section and the remote ReadyDLNA D7800 icon is in the Media Devices section if DLNA is enabled in the modem router 2 If the icons do not display click the Refresh button to update the page If the local LAN and the remote LAN are using the same IP scheme the remote ReadyDLNA D7800 icon does not display in the Media Devices section and the D7800 Gateway icon does not display in the Network Infrastructure section 3 To access the USB device click the ReadySHARE icon 4 To access media on the modem router s network click the ReadyDLNA D7800 icon Use VPN to Access Your Internet Service at Home When you are away from home and you access the Internet you usually use a local Internet service provider For example at a coffee shop you might be given a code that lets you use the coffee shop s Internet service account to surf the web The modem router lets you use a VPN connection to access your own Internet service when you are away from home You might want to do this if you travel to a geographic location that does not support all the Internet services that you use at home For example your Netflix account might work at home but not in a different country Set Up
35. 64 bit encryption e 128 bit Standard WEP encryption using 104 128 bit encryption This selection provides higher encryption security Specify the active key by selecting the Key 1 Key 2 Key 3 or Key 4 radio button Only one key can be the active key To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter the key value for the key that you specified as the active key Enter a value for the key For 64 bit WEP enter 10 hexadecimal digits any combination of 0 9 A F The key values are not case sensitive e For 128 bit WEP enter 26 hexadecimal digits any combination of 0 9 A F The key values are not case sensitive To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter the key value for the key that you specified as the active key Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Make sure that you can reconnect over WiFi to the network with its new security settings If you cannot connect over WiFi check the following Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 107 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e If your computer or WiFi device is already connected to another WiFi network in your area disconnect it from that WiFi network and connect it to the WiFi network that the modem router provides Some WiFi devices automatically connect to the first open network without WiFi security that they discover e lf your computer or WiFi device is trying to connect to your network with its
36. A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Wait for the modem router to determine if newer firmware is available This process might take a few minutes If the modem router detects new firmware the modem router displays a message at the top of the page Click the message To upgrade the modem router with the latest firmware click the Yes button After the upgrade the modem router restarts WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the upgrade For example do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white Access the Modem Router With the NETGEAR genie App The genie app is the easy dashboard for managing monitoring and repairing your home network from a smartphone tablet or computer The genie app can help you with the following Automatically repair common WiFi network problems Easily manage modem router features such as Live Parental Controls guest access Internet traffic meter speed test and more Share and stream music or videos Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 42 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To use the genie app to access the mode
37. Enter the saved answers to your security questions Click the Continue button A page displays your recovered password 8 Click the Login again button A login window opens 9 With your recovered password log in to the modem router Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default Settings Under some circumstances for example if you lost track of the changes that you made to the modem router settings or you move the modem router to a different network you might want to erase the configuration and reset it to factory default settings If you do not know the current IP address of the modem router first try to use an IP scanner application to detect the IP address before you reset the modem router to factory default settings To reset the modem router to factory default settings you can use either the Reset button on the back of the modem router or the Erase function However if you cannot find the IP address or lost the password to access the modem router you must use the Reset button Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 221 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 After you reset the modem router to factory default settings the user name is admin the password is password the LAN IP address is 192 168 0 1 which is the same as www routerlogin net and the DHCP server is enabled For a list of factory default settings see Factory Settings on page 295 Use the Reset Button AN CAUTION
38. From the Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 7 Select the Yes radio button If you select the No radio button you are taken to the Internet Setup page after you click the Next button For more information see one of the following sections e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 45 8 9 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Click the Next button The Setup Wizard searches your Internet connection for servers and protocols to determine your ISP configuration Detecting the Internet Connection This process can take a minute or two please wait gt Ps When the modem router is connected to the Internet the Congratulations page displays and you successfully completed the setup process If the Congratulations page does not display other pages might display and you might need to provide more information in which case you must continue with the next step The pages that display depend on your type of ISP connection and configuration Congratulations You are successfully connected to the Intemet This router is preset with the following unique wireless network name SSID and network key password 2 4GHz
39. In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only 11 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 PPPoE Connection An IPv6 PPPoE connection is based on a dynamic IPv6 address that a PPPoE service assigns to the modem router Note Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you To set up an IPv6 PPPoE Internet connection 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays Manage the Internet Settings Manually 89 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 From the Internet Connection Type menu select PPPoE statusRetresh Px Cancel Internet Connection Type PPPoE X Login Password Service Name If Required Connection Mode Always On Router s IPv6 Address On WAN Not Available LAN Setup Router s IPv6 Address On LAN Not Available IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config Use This Interface ID 0 10 2 0 IPv6 Filtering Secured Open The modem router automatically detects the
40. Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network The modem router comes with preset security This means that the WiFi network name SSID network key password and security option encryption protocol are preset in the factory The preset SSID and password are uniquely generated for every device to protect and maximize your WiFi security You can find the preset SSID and password on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 IMPORTANT We recommend that you do not change your preset security settings If you do decide to change your preset security settings make a note of the new settings and store the note in a safe place where you can easily find it View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings You can view or change the basic WiFi settings and WiFi security The modem router simultaneously supports the 2 4 GHz band for 802 11b g n devices and the 5 GHz band for 802 1 1a n ac devices Tip If you do decide to change the WiFi settings of the modem router s main network use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when the new WiFi settings take effect To view or change the basic WiFi settings 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensit
41. Mask The subnet mask that is assigned by the ISP to the modem router To establish the Internet connection when the connection is down click the Connect button To terminate the Internet connection when the connection is active click the Disconnect button Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes View Establish or Terminate the PPTP or L2TP Internet Connection You can view information about a PPTP or L2TP Internet connection of the modem router and establish or terminate such a connection This information displays only if the modem router connects to the ISP network over a PPTP or L2TP connection A PPTP or L2TP connection can function only over an Ethernet WAN connection To view the status of the PPTP or L2TP Internet connection or establish or terminate the PPTP or L2TP Internet connection 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 233 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The ADVANCED Home page displays 5 In the Internet Port pane click the Connection Status button The Connection Status pop
42. OR the Internet Connection iz You are not yet connected to the Internet Select Country Country Select Internet Service Provider Internet Service Provider AT amp T ay Do you want NETGEAR Genie to help Yes No I want to configure the Internet connection myself have saved the router settings in a file and want to restore the router to those settings If the Configuring the Internet Connection page displays skip to Step 12 If it does not display do the following a Inthe address field of the web browser enter www routerlogin net b When prompted enter admin for the user name and password for the password If the Configuring the Internet Connection page displays skip to Step 12 If it still does not display see Step 11 11 If the browser cannot display the web page do the following a Make sure that the computer is connected to one of the four Ethernet LAN ports or over WiFi to the modem router b Make sure that the Power LED of the modem router is lit solid white Make sure that your browser does not cache the previous page by closing and reopening the browser Clear the browser cache e Ifthe computer is set to a static fixed IP address this setting is uncommon either change the computer to obtain an IP address automatically from the modem router through DHCP or change the IP address of the computer to a static IP address in the 192 168 1 2 192 168 1 254 range 12 From the Country menu sel
43. PPPoA connection can function only over a VDSL connection To view the status of the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet connection or establish or terminate the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet connection 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays 5 Inthe Internet Port pane click the Connection Status button The Connection Status pop up window opens The fields that display depend on the type of Internet connection Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 232 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following table describes the fields for a PPPoE connection PO N Connection Time The time elapsed since the connection was established Connection Status The status can be Connected or Disconnected Negotiation The negotiation can be a series of dashes which indicates that the connection is not established or successful Success Authentication The authentication can be a series of dashes which indicates that the connection is not established or successful Success IP Address The IP address that is assigned by the ISP to the modem router Subnet
44. Specify the internal ports by one of these methods e Ifthe external and internal ports are the same leave the Use the same port range for Internal port check box selected Internal Ending Port If the external and internal ports are different in the Internal Starting Port field enter the starting port number for the service or application The Internal Ending Port field is populated automatically Internal IP address Either enter an IP address in the Internal IP address field or select the radio button for an attached device that is listed in the table The modem router applies the new rule to the device that you select 9 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The rule is added to the table on the Port Forwarding Port Triggering page Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 270 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Change a Port Forwarding Rule You can change an existing port forwarding rule To change a port forwarding rule 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering Port Forwarding Port Triggering P
45. Status Device Name IP Address MAC Address Connection Type Blocked ANDROID 192 168 1 3 C0 D1 01 B0 F0 D1 Wireless NETGEAR84 5G Allowed BUSINESSLAPTOP 192 168 1 2 60 66 66 DA66 7C Wireless NETGEAR84 gt View list of allowed devices not currently connected to the network gt View list of blocked devices not currently connected to the network 9 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage Network Access Control Lists You can use access control to block or allow access to your network An access control list ACL functions with the MAC addresses of wired and WiFi devices that can either access your entire network or are blocked from accessing your entire network The modem router can detect the MAC addresses of devices that are connected to the network and list the MAC addresses of devices that were connected to the network Each network device owns a MAC address which is a unique 12 character physical address containing the hexadecimal characters 0 9 a f or A F uppercase or lowercase only and separated by colons for example 00 09 AB CD EF 01 Typically the MAC address is on the label of the WiFi card or network interface device If you cannot see the label you can display the MAC address using the network configuration utilities of the computer You might also find the MAC addresses through the web pages of the modem router see View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 Add Devices to or Remove Them From t
46. WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA WPA2 Enterprise Security Options WPA WPA2 Enterprise WPA Mode WPA TKIP WPA2 AES v RADIUS server IP Address RADIUS server Port 1812 RADIUS server Shared Secret 6 Inthe Security Options WPA WPA2 Enterprise section enter the settings as described in the following table rot esermton ee s sidCY From the WPA Mode menu select the enterprise mode WPA TKIP WPA2 AES This type of security enables WiFi devices that support either WPA or WPA2 to join the modem router s WiFi network WPA2 AES WPA2 provides a secure connection but some older WiFi devices do not detect WPA2 and support only WPA If your network includes such older devices select WPA TKIP WPA2 AES security If your network includes older devices only select WPA TKIP security WPA TKIP WPA provides a secure connection If your network includes older devices only select this type of security Group Key Update Interval Enter the interval in seconds after which the RADIUS group key is updated The default interval is 3600 seconds RADIUS server IP Address Enter the IPv4 address of the RADIUS server to which the WiFi network can connect RADIUS server Port Enter the number of the port on the modem router that is used to access the RADIUS server for authentication The default port number is 1812 RADIUS server Shared Secret Enter the shared secret RADIUS password that is
47. Wi Fi multimedia settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac check box e To enable WMM QoS for the 5 GHz radio select the Enable WMM Wi Fi multimedia settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac check box By default WMM QoS is enabled for the 5 GHz radio Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Optimize Performance 145 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manage Beamforming The modem router supports beamforming to enhance the WiFi range and performance for your WiFi devices With beamforming when you connect to the WiFi network the modem router actively tracks your device and directs WiFi to your device rather than just blasting it out in all directions The modem router uses explicit and implicit beamforming to improve WiFi performance Explicit beamforming requires the devices to support beamforming Typically 802 11ac devices support beamforming Implicit beamforming means that the modem router supports beamforming even with devices that do not support beamforming The modem router supports implicit beamforming for both 2 4 GHz and 5 GHz devices which means that the modem router can provide beamforming benefits of better range and performance for all WiFi devices even older 802 11 a b g n devices and not just the latest WiFi devices Both explicit and implicit beamforming are enabled by default Explicit beamforming is always enabled you cannot disable it but you can disable implicit beamforming To manage
48. a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Control Access to the Internet 136 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt E mail Turn E mail Notification On Send alerts and logs through e mail Primary E mail Address Your Outgoing Mail Server Outgoing Mail Server Port Number My mail server requires authentication User Name Password Send Alert Immediately When someone attempts to visit a blocked site Send logs according to this schedule hen log ts ful Day Sunda Time 0 00 am p m 5 Select the Turn Email Notification On check box 6 Enter the settings as described in the following table e ee eee eee eee eee Send alerts and logs through e mail Your Outgoing Mail Server Enter the name of your ISP s outgoing SMTP mail server such as mail mylSP com You might be able to find this information in the configuration window of your email program If you leave this field blank log and alert messages are not sent Send to This E mail Address Enter the email address to which logs and alerts must be sent Secure connection use SSL Select this check box to send messages over a secure connection
49. a0 63 91 7a 14 99 DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option 60 Client Identifier String option 61 11 Enter the ADSL settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 52 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee bea o Multiplexing Method Use VLANID Priority 0 7 Bridge Mode IPTV interface only Account Name Domain Name Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Select LLC BASED or VC BASED as indicated by your ISP The multiplexing method can either be virtual circuit VC based or logical link control LLC based Enter a number between 0 and 255 for the virtual circuit number for the virtual path identifier VPI as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VPI setting leave the default setting 8 The VPI might be required not only for a VC based connection but also for an LLC based connection Enter a number between 32 and 65535 for the virtual circuit number for the virtual channel identifier VCI as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VCI setting leave the default setting 35 The VCI might be required not only for a VC based connection but also for an LLC based connection Select the Use VLANID check box and enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP A VLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your
50. and password for the password If the Configuring the Internet Connection page displays skip to Step 13 If it still does not display see Step 12 12 If the browser cannot display the web page do the following a Make sure that the computer is connected to one of the four Ethernet LAN ports or over WiFi to the modem router b Make sure that the Power LED of the modem router is lit solid white Make sure that your browser does not cache the previous page by closing and reopening the browser d Clear the browser cache If the computer is set to a static fixed IP address this setting is uncommon either change the computer to obtain an IP address automatically from the modem router through DHCP or change the IP address of the computer to a static IP address in the 192 168 1 2 192 168 1 254 range 13 From the Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 27 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 14 From the Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 15 Select the Yes radio button 16 Click the Next button Detecting the Internet Connection This process can take a minute or two please wait gt rk When the modem router is connected to the Internet the Congratulations page displays and you successfully complet
51. as a WiFi access point see Set Up the Modem Router as a WiFi Access Point Only on page 252 Troubleshoot the Internet Connection If your modem router cannot access the Internet check the DSL connection then the WAN TCP IP connection Troubleshoot the DSL Internet Link If your modem router is unable to access the Internet first determine whether the DSL cable or fiber link with the service provider is working The DSL Internet LED indicates the state of this connection Troubleshooting 286 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 DSL Internet LED Is Solid White If the DSL Internet LED lights solid white the DSL cable or fiber connection is good You can be confident that the service provider connected your line correctly and that your wiring is correct DSL Internet LED Is Blinking White DSL Connection Only If the DSL Internet LED amp is blinking white your modem router is attempting to make a DSL connection with your ISP If the modem router establishes a DSL connection the DSL Internet LED turns solid white This connection process generally lasts several minutes If the DSL Internet LED does not turn solid white disconnect all telephones on the line If this solves the problem reconnect the telephones one at a time being sure to use a microfilter on each telephone If the microfilters are connected correctly you can connect all your telephones If disconnecting telephones does not resu
52. b Select the None of the above radio button Click the Next button 17 Only if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the IP address for the Internet connection Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 36 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection IP address If this page does not display continue with Step 18 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection IP Address Did your Internet Service Provider ISP assign to you a fixed static IP address This is a very rare special deployment Select an option and click Next to proceed Yes My ISP assigned a fixed static IP address to me No did not get a fixed static IP address from my ISP don t know Take one of the following actions If your ISP assigned you a fixed static IP address do the following a Select the Yes radio button b Click the Next button Enter the fixed IP settings assigned by your Internet Service Provider and click Next to proceed My IP Address Subnet Mask Default Gateway Preferred ONS Server Alternate ONS Server c Enter the address information that your ISP gave you for your fixed IP address configuration d Click the Next button e lf your ISP did not assign you a fixed IP address or you do not know if your ISP assigned you a fixed IP a
53. by default 7 Specify the port number for accessing the modem router s web pages The default is 8443 which is a common alternate for HTTPS For greater security enter a custom port number for accessing the modem router s web pages remotely Choose a number from 1024 to 65535 but do not use the number of any common service port 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 245 Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 1 3 This chapter describes how you can manage the advanced WiFi features of the modem router For information about the basic WiFi settings see Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings on page 96 The chapter includes the following sections Set Up a WiFi Schedule on page 247 Manage the WPS Settings on page 249 Manage Advanced WiFi Settings on page 250 Set Up the Modem Router as a WiFi Access Point Only on page 252 Set Up a WiFi Bridge on page 253 For information about setting up an access control list ACL and managing WiFi access for enhanced security see Manage Network Access Control Lists on page 121 246 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up a WiFi Schedule You can use this feature to turn off the WiFi signal from your modem router at times when you do not need a WiFi connection For example you might turn it off for the weekend if you leave town Note You can set up a WiFi schedule only if the modem router
54. change the modem router MAC address that the modem router uses For more information see one of the following sections e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Make sure that the Ethernet cables are securely plugged in Make sure that your computer or device does not use a static IP address but is configured to receive an IP address automatically with DHCP For most devices DHCP is the default setting Troubleshooting 283 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Troubleshoot With the LEDs When you turn on the power the LEDs light as described here Make sure that the WiFi settings in your WiFi device and modem router match exactly For a device that is connected over WiFi the WiFi network name SSID and WiFi security settings of the modem router and WiFi computer must match exactly The default SSID and password are on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 Make sure that your WiFi device supports the security that you are using for your WiFi network WEP WPA or WPA2 For information about WiFi security settings see Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network on page 97 Make sure that the modem router is not too far from your WiFi device or too close Move your WiFi device near the modem router but at leas
55. enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP AVLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting Priority 0 7 If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 Account Name Enter the account name as indicated by your ISP This name might also be called the host name If your ISP did not provide you with an account name or host name leave the default setting Domain Name Enter the domain name as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a domain name leave this field blank Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Use Static IP Address Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Use IP over ATM IPoA Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for IPoA service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Ad
56. for the cable connection or Internet connection or the connection is down For a WiFi network the network is disabled or down An amber exclamation mark PM indicates that the cable port or Internet port is configured but cannot get an Internet connection for example because the cable is disconnected that a WiFi network is enabled but unprotected or that another situation that requires your attention occurred The following table describes the fields of the six panes on the ADVANCED Home page Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 225 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e ee S eee eee Router Information Hardware Version The modem router model Firmware Version The version of the modem router firmware If you upgrade the firmware on the modem router the version changes GUI Language Version The version of the modem router language for its web pages If you upgrade the firmware on modem router the language version might change too Operation Mode The operation mode Router or AP Mode of the modem router For information about how to change the operation mode see Set Up the Modem Router as a WiFi Access Point Only on page 252 LAN Port The settings of the LAN port For information about how to configure the LAN settings see Manage the Modem Router s LAN IP Address Settings on page 205 and Disable the Built In DHCP Server on page 210 MAC Address The Media Access Control M
57. go to the WiFi device and press its WPS button to join the modem router s main WiFi network without entering a password After the modem router establishes a WPS connection the WiFi LED lights solid white and the Add WPS Client page displays a confirmation message To verify that the WiFi device is connected to the modem router s main WiFi network select BASIC gt Attached Devices The WiFi device displays onscreen Use WPS With the PIN Method To use the PIN method to connect a WiFi device to the modem router s WiFi network you must know the PIN of the WiFi device that you are trying to connect To let a WiFi device join the modem router s WiFi network using WPS with the PIN method Ws 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 109 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt WPS Wizard The page displays a description of the WPS method 5 Click the Next button The Add WPS Client page adjusts The Push Button recommended radio button is selected by default 6 Select the PIN Number radio button Select a setup method Push Button
58. in the User Name field enter the user name for your account e Fora NETGEAR account in the Email field enter the email address for your account In the Password 6 32 characters field enter the password for your DDNS account Click the Apply button Your settings are saved To verify that your Dynamic DNS service is enabled in the modem router click the Show Status button Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 171 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A message displays the Dynamic DNS status Change the Dynamic DNS Settings You can change the settings for your Dynamic DNS account To change your settings 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http Awww routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Dynamic DNS The Dynamic DNS page displays Change your DDNS account settings as necessary Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Access Storage Devices Through the Internet If you connect a USB storage device to the modem router you can access the USB device through the Internet when you are not home After you gain access you can use FTP to share files on the USB device
59. modem router provides Some WiFi devices automatically connect to the first open network without WiFi security that they discover e Does your WiFi device display as an attached device See View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 If it does it is connected to the network e Are you using the correct network name SSID and password Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 114 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Control the WiFi Radios The modem router provides internal WiFi radios that broadcast signals in the 2 4 GHz and 5 GHz ranges By default they are on so that you can connect over WiFi to the modem router When the WiFi radios are off you can still use an Ethernet cable for a LAN connection to the modem router You can turn the WiFi radios on and off with the WiFi On Off button on the modem router or you can log in to the modem router and enable or disable the WiFi radios through the modem router web pages If you are close to the modem router it might be easier to press the WiFi On Off button If you are away from the modem router or already logged in it might be easier to enable or disable the radios through the modem router web pages You can also turn the WiFi radios off and on based on a schedule See Set Up a WiFi Schedule on page 247 Use the WiFi On Off Button To turn the WiFi radios off and on with the WiFi On Off button e Press the WiFi On Off button on the top panel of the
60. not assign you a fixed IP address or you do not know if your ISP assigned you a fixed IP address do the following a Select either the No or the I don t know radio button b Click the Next button Problem Detecting the Internet Connection MAC Address If you previously connected to your Internet service with a computer or another router NETGEAR Genie can use the same MAC address that worked before A MAC address is a unique number You can find the MAC address of the computer or router on its product label Enter the MAC address here format AABBCCODEEFF c Enter the MAC address of the computer or router with which you previously were able to connect to the Internet You might find the MAC address on the product label of your device Enter the MAC address in the AABBCCDDEEFF format not in the AA BB CC DD EE FF format d Click the Next button 12 If the Congratulations page still does not display and the modem router still does not connect to the Internet do the following a Review all your settings and make sure that you selected the correct options and entered everything correctly b Run the Setup Wizard one more time Manage the Internet Settings Manually 49 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 c Contact your ISP to verify that you are using the correct configuration information d Read Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 e If problems persist register your NET
61. notice that some devices are not being updated or reached correctly it might be necessary to increase this value Click the Apply button The UPnP Portmap Table displays the IP address of each UPnP device that is accessing the modem router and which ports internal and external that device opened The UPnP Portmap Table also displays what type of port is open and whether that port is still active for each IP address To refresh the information in the UPnP Portmap table click the Refresh button Optimize Performance 147 Share a Storage Device 7 This chapter describes how to access and manage a storage device attached to your modem router ReadySHARE lets you access and share a USB or eSATA storage device connected to the modem router If your storage device uses special drivers it is not compatible Note You can use a USB port on the modem router only to connect a USB storage device such as a flash drive or hard drive or a printer Do not connect a computer USB modem CD drive or DVD drive to a modem router USB port The chapter includes the following sections Connect an eSATA Device to the Modem Router on page 149 USB Device Requirements on page 149 Connect a USB Device to the Modem Router on page 149 Access a Storage Device Connected to the Modem Router on page 150 Back Up Windows Computers With ReadySHARE Vault on page 151 Back Up Mac Computers With Time Machine on page 152 Manage Access to a Storage Device on page 1
62. of the modem router Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 13 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Table 2 LED and button descriptions DSL Internet 2 4 GHz WiFi 5 GHz WiFi USB 3 0 port 1 and USB 3 0 port 2 Solid amber The modem router is starting If the Power LED lights solid amber during any other time a power on self test POST failure or device malfunction occurred For more information see Power LED Remains Solid Amber on page 285 Blinking amber The modem router was reset to factory default settings and is restarting For more information see Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default Settings on page 221 Solid white The modem router is ready Off Power is not supplied to the modem router For more information see Power LED Is Off on page 285 Solid white The modem router is connected to a DSL service or cable or fiber modem and detected an Internet connection Solid amber The modem router is not connected to a DSL service or cable or fiber modem or did not detect an Internet connection For more information see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Blinking white The modem router is negotiating the best possible speed on the DSL line Alternating white and amber The traffic meter is enabled and the traffic limit is reached Off The modem router cannot connect to the Internet or the Internet connection failed Solid white The 2 4 GHz WiFi
63. old settings before you changed the settings update the WiFi network selection in your computer or WiFi device to match the current settings for your network e Does your WiFi device display as an attached device See View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 If it does it is connected to the network Are you using the correct WiFi network name SSID and password Use WPS to Add a Device to the WiFi Network WPS Wi Fi Protected Setup lets you connect a computer or WiFi device to the modem router s network without entering the WiFi network passphrase or key Instead you use a WPS button or enter a PIN to connect If you use the push button method the WiFi device that you are trying to connect must provide either a physical button or a software button If you use the PIN method you must know the PIN of the WiFi device that you are trying to connect WPS supports WPA and WPA2 WiFi security If your modem router network is open no WiFi security is set which is not the default setting for the modem router connecting with WPS automatically sets WPA WPA2 WiFi security on the modem router network and generates a random passphrase You can view this passphrase see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 Use WPS With the Push Button Method For you to use the push button method to connect a WiFi device to the modem router s WiFi network the WiFi device that you are trying to connect must provide either a phy
64. pane check to see that the IP Address field shows a valid IP address If the field shows 0 0 0 0 your modem router did not obtain an IP address from your ISP If your modem router cannot obtain an IP address from the ISP the problem might be one of the following e Your Internet service provider ISP might require a login program Ask your ISP whether they require PPP over Ethernet PPPoE or some other type of login e If you selected a login program the service name user name or password could be incorrectly set Before you make any changes verify that the modem router can get a PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP connection see Verify the PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP Connection on page 289 e Your ISP might check for your computer s host name Assign the computer host name of your ISP account as the account name For more information see one of the following sections Troubleshooting 288 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 If your ISP allows only one Ethernet MAC address to connect to Internet and checks for your computer s MAC address inform your ISP that you bought a new network device and ask them to use the modem router s MAC address Configure your modem router to clone your computer s MAC address For more informati
65. range of ports enter the end port for the range If the service or application uses a single port repeat the port number that you entered in the Starting Port field Service Type User Defined Enter the name of the custom service or application Specify which devices on your LAN or LAN users are affected by the rule based on their IP addresses Only This IP Address Enter the required address in the fields to apply the rule to a single device on your LAN IP Address Range Enter the required addresses in the start and end fields to apply the rule to a range of devices All IP Addresses All computers and devices on your LAN are covered by this rule By default the All IP Addresses radio button is selected Click the Add button The new rule is added to the Service Table on the Block Services page Control Access to the Internet 132 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Change an Outbound Firewall Rule You can change an existing outbound firewall rule To change an outbound firewall rule 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Services Blo
66. shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s LAN interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available 6 Select an IP Address Assignment radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPv 6 client function e Auto Config This is the default setting Manage the Internet Settings Manually 82 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To specify the interface ID for the IPv6 address of the modem router s LAN interface select the Use This Interface ID check box and enter the interface ID If you do not specify an ID here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address Select the IPv6 filtering mode e Secured In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 6to4 Tunnel Connection With an IPv6 connection your modem router creates a 6to4 tunnel to a remote relay router Make sure that the IPv4 Internet connection is working before you apply the 6to4 tunnel settin
67. the Apply button The device is added to the allowed list on the Access Control page 9 7 To remove a device from allowed list do the following a Select the check box for the device b Click the Delete button The device is removed from the allowed list 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Use Keywords to Block Internet Sites You can block keywords and domains websites to prevent certain types of HTTP traffic from accessing your network By default keyword blocking is disabled and no domains are blocked Control Access to the Internet 124 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up Blocking You can set up blocking of specific keywords and domains to occur continuously or according to a schedule To set up keyword and domain blocking 1 2 5 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Sites Block Sites CCZ EED To learn more about advanced content filtering and keyword blocking features from NETGEAR please go to www netgear compe Keyword Blocking Never Per Schedule Always Type keyword or domain name here Add Keyw
68. the filtering level page displays 10 Select the radio button for the filtering level that you want and click the Next button The Setup is complete page displays 11 Click the Take me to the status screen button The Status page displays Parental Controls are now set up for the modem router 12 To enable Parental Controls click the Enable Live Parental Controls button Allow or Block Access to Your Network You can use access control to block or allow access of devices to your network You define access by selecting or specifying the MAC addresses of the wired and WiFi devices that either can access your entire network or are blocked from accessing your entire network Enable and Manage Network Access Control When you enable access control you must select whether new devices are allowed to access the network or are blocked from accessing the network By default currently connected devices are allowed to access the network but you can also block these devices from accessing the network To set up network access control 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Control Access to the Internet 119 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive
69. to the default WiFi network of the modem router a On your computer or WiFi device find and select the WiFi network The WiFi network name SSID is on the product label b Join the WiFi network and enter the WiFi password The password network key is on the product label Your computer or WiFi device connects to the modem router s WiFi network Note Ifthe computer is set to a static fixed IP address this setting is uncommon either change the computer to obtain an IP address automatically from the modem router through DHCP or change the IP address of the computer to a static IP address in the 192 168 1 2 192 168 1 254 range 11 Launch a web browser Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 26 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The modem router checks the Internet connection sie NETGEAR genie Pr terne iz You are not yet connected to the Intemet Select Country Country Select Internet Service Provider Internet Service Provider AT amp T X Do you want NETGEAR Genie to help Yes No I want to configure the Internet connection myself have saved the router settings in a file and want to restore the router to those settings If the Configuring the Internet Connection page displays skip to Step 13 If it does not display do the following a Inthe address field of the web browser enter www routerlogin net b When prompted enter admin for the user name
70. to the modem router you might need to log in again Select BASIC gt Internet The Internet Setup page displays From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 10 Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected 11 Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the Yes radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 77 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure a cable or fiber connection with a login and PPTP service Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No Internet Service Provider PPTP Login Password Connection Mode Always On X Idle Timeout In Minutes My IP Address IP Subnet Mask Server Address Gateway IP Address Connection ID Name Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address a0 63 91 7a 14 99 12 Enter the cable or fiber settings as described in the following table a bee o Internet Service Pro
71. to the network 2 Enter http Awww routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Remote Management Remote Management CCZ EnH Turn Remote Management On Remote Management Address https 203 0 113 87 8443 Allow Remote Access By Only This Computer IP Address Range From To Everyone Port Number 8443 Select the Turn Remote Management On check box In the Allow Remote Access By section specify the external IP addresses to be allowed to access the modem router s remote management Note For enhanced security restrict access to as few external IP addresses as practical Select one of the following radio buttons and configure the options accordingly To allow access from a single IP address on the Internet select the Only This Computer radio button Enter the IP address to be allowed access Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 244 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e To allow access from a range of IP addresses on the Internet select the IP Address Range radio button Enter a beginning and ending IP address to define the allowed range e To allow access from any IP address on the Internet select the Everyone radio button This radio button is selected
72. you are using the recommended addressing scheme your computer s address is in the range of 192 168 1 2 to 192 168 1 254 e Make sure that your computer can reach the modem router s DHCP server Recent versions of Windows and Mac OS generate and assign an IP address if the computer cannot reach a DHCP server These autogenerated addresses are in the range of 169 254 x x If your IP address is in this range check the connection from the computer to the modem router and reboot your computer e If your modem router s IP address was changed and you do not know the current IP address use an IP scanner application to detect the IP address If you still cannot find the IP address clear the modem router s configuration to factory defaults This sets the modem router s IP address to 192 168 1 1 For more information see Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default Settings on page 221 and Factory Settings on page 295 e Make sure that Java JavaScript or ActiveX is enabled in your browser If you are using Internet Explorer click the Refresh button to be sure that the Java applet is loaded e Try quitting the browser and launching it again e Make sure that you are using the correct login information The user name is admin and the default password is password Make sure that Caps Lock is off when you enter this information e If you are attempting to set up your modem router behind an existing router in your network set up the modem router
73. 00 168 shari 443 o FTP fip readyshare routeriogin nevshares 21 F FTP via internet 1192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space 5 WD7800 T_Drive All no password All no password UA STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB gt WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgear com Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router Share a Storage Device 157 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Select the FTP check box 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved View Network Folders on a Device You can view or change the network folders on a USB storage device connected to the modem router To view network folders 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Share a Storage Device 158 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Apply gt Network Device N
74. 222 Ethernet LAN ports Four Gigabit Ethernet RJ 45 LAN ports to connect the modem router to LAN devices These ports are colored yellow Internet port One Gigabit Ethernet RJ 45 WAN port to connect the modem router to a fiber or cable modem This port is colored red Note You can use either the Internet port or the DSL port for WAN connectivity DSL port One RJ 11 DSL port for connecting the modem router to an ADSL or VDSL line This port is colored gray In the previous figure the DSL port is marked VDSL Note You can use either the DSL port or the Internet port for WAN connectivity DC power connector Connect the power adapter that came in the product package to the DC power connector Power On Off button Press the Power On Off button to provide power to the modem router USB Ports on the Left Panel Two 3 0 USB ports are located on the left panel Figure 4 USB ports eSATA Port on the Right Panel An eSATA port is located on the right panel Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 16 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Figure 5 eSATA port Connect an eSATA Device To connect an eSATA device e Use an eSATA cable to connect your device to the eSATA port on the side of the modem router as shown Bottom Panel Product Label The product label on the bottom panel of the modem router lists the login information WiFi network name SSID and password network key serial num
75. 4 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Click the Create Network Folder button Create Network Folder USB Device U STORE N GO Foe Share Name Read Access All no password Write Access All no password v7 x Close Window If this pop up window does not display your web browser might be blocking pop ups If it is change the browser settings to allow pop ups From the USB Device menu select the USB drive Note We recommend that you do not attach more than one drive to each USB port for example through a USB hub Click the Browse button Another pop up window opens Navigate to the folder in which you want to create a new share and select the folder Click the OK button The pop up window closes The folder displays in the Folder field in the Create Network Folder pop up window In the Share Name field type the name of the share From the Read Access menu and the Write Access menu select the settings that you want All no password the default allows all users to access the network folder The other option is that only the admin user is allowed access to the network folder The password for admin is the same one that you use to log in to the modem router Click the Apply button The folder is added on the storage device Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes Share a Storage Device 161 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7
76. 4 GHz or 5 GHz 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network of the modem router that you are setting up as a WiFi bridge Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 254 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Wireless Bridge The Wireless Bridge page displays Select the Enable Bridge mode check box Wireless Bridge CZD ELED V Enable Bridge mode setup bridge mode wireless settings Choose IP Address settings on this bridge Get dynamically from existing router D Use fixed IP Address not recommended Note After you click Apply this device will change to a new IP assigned by your existing router therefore this web page might not be available Please close and restart web browser to http Avww routerlogin net again Click the setup bridge mode wireless settings button Wireless Settings CCZ GELS Please choose a wireless network Wireless Network 2 4GHz b g n v Name SSID NETGEAR Bridge Security Options None WEP WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES Enter the WiFi settings of the modem router that is connected to the Internet modem that is the other modem router
77. 4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Dynamic DNS Dynamic DNS Use a Dynamic DNS Service Service Provider Do you have a NETGEAR DDNS or a No IP DDNS account Yes No G m gt Please enter the following information for registration Host Name mynetgear com Email Password 6 32 characters Register By submitting this form agree to the terms of service and that will only create one free account Select the Use a Dynamic DNS Service check box From the Service Provider menu select NETGEAR Select the No radio button In the Host Name field enter the name that you want to use for your URL The host name is sometimes called the domain name Your free URL includes the host name that you specify and ends with mynetgear com For example enter MyName mynetgear com In the Email field enter the email address that you want to use for your account In the Password 6 32 characters field enter the password that you want to use for your account Click the Register button 12 Follow the onscreen instructions to register for your NETGEAR Dynamic DNS service Specify a DNS Account That You Already Created If you already created a Dynamic DNS account with NETGEAR No IP or Dyn you can set up the modem router to use your account To set up Dynamic DNS if you already created an account 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is conne
78. 5 Use VPN to Access Your Network 262 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To open a VPN tunnel 1 Launch the OpenVPN application with administrator privileges The OpenVPN icon displays in the Windows taskbar Tip You can create a shortcut to the VPN program then use the shortcut to access the settings and select the run as administrator check box Then every time you use this shortcut OpenVPN automatically runs with administrator privileges 2 Right click the OpenVPN icon View Log Edit Config Change Password Settings Exit 3 Select Connect The VPN connection is established You can do the following e Launch a web browser and log in to your modem router e Use Windows file manager to access the modem router s USB device and download files Use VPN to Access Your Network 263 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Use VPN to Access the Modem Router s USB Device and Media From a Windows Computer To access a USB device and download files 1 In Windows file manager select the Network folder Organize Network and Sharing Center Add a printer Add a wireless device 4 amp Favorites 4 Computer 2 E Desktop je Downloads p A NETGEAR1 g A READYSHARE es Recent Places amp Vault Timeline 4 Media Devices 3 m a i MD ccan 4009 Libraries lifestyle NAS ReadyNAS 104 NETGEAR1 Netgearuser ReadyDLNA D7800 d Documents
79. 54 Enable FTP Access Within Your Network on page 157 View Network Folders on a Device on page 158 Add a Network Folder on a Storage Device on page 159 Change a Network Folder Including Read and Write Access on a USB Drive on page 162 Approve Storage Devices on page 163 Safely Remove a USB Device on page 165 Note For more information about ReadySHARE features visit netgear com readyshare 148 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Connect an eSATA Device to the Modem Router You can connect an eSATA device to the eSATA port located on the right side of the modem router Figure 10 eSATA port USB Device Requirements The modem router works with most USB compliant external flash and hard drives For the most up to date list of USB devices that the modem router supports visit kbserver netgear com readyshare Some USB external hard drives and flash drives require you to load the drivers onto the computer before the computer can access the USB device Such USB devices do not work with the modem router The modem router supports the following file system types for full read write access FAT16 FAT32 NTFS NTFS with compression format enabled Ext2 Ext3 Ext4 The modem router supports the following file system types with read only access HFS HFS Connect a USB Device to the Modem Router ReadySHARE lets you access and share a USB device connected to a modem router USB port If your USB
80. 6 Troubleshoot the Internet CONMECTION ccececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeetetaaeeeeeeaas 286 Troubleshoot the DSL Internet LINK eee eeeeeceeeeeeecceeeeeneeeeeeetseeesteneeeees 286 DSL Internet LED Is Solid White ccccccscscseessssssssrsseeeseseesseeeees 287 DSL Internet LED Is Blinking White DSL Connection Only 287 DS Internet LED IS Ol viscera sincansavesninddrexasenacscabeaciaiad wasaniiadeasaacaeianadas 287 Obtain an Internet IP AdGreSS i iicsvccecsnriitictictdenestezsscenimiiunsinnlataceuenniiias 288 Verify the PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP Connection cceeeeeeeees 289 Troubleshoot Internet BroWSiNG ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeesenaeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeees 290 Changes Are Not Saved stsicsiscscsencaisussesntiarnsnnida egomnncnacteerindiauteedysehnasenseetiamede 290 Troubleshoot the WiFi CORNGCUVINY cc 2xticcmtec cisctenet ca de ctepucaina oa aeceateses 291 Troubleshoot Your Network Using the Ping Utility eee eeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeee 291 Test the LAN Path to Your Modem Route l s ssecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 291 Test the Path From Your Computer to a Remote DeVICE cccececeee 292 Chapter 17 Supplemental Information Factory Setting Sises s e E RERE D ahem 295 Technical Sp cifications ssn eee 297 Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 1 The NETGEAR Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 i
81. 800 Change a Network Folder Including Read and Write Access on a USB Drive You can change network folders on storage devices connected to the USB port on the modem router To change a network folder 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Apply gt Network Device Name 07800 Fa Edit Workgroup Workgroup m Network Neighborhood MacShare 107800 V HTTP htto readyshare routerlogin nevshares 80 B HTTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shari 443 o FTP ftp ireadyshare routerlogin netshares 21 FTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space 5 WD7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB gt WO7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycioud netgear com Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router 5 Inthe Available Network Folders table select a dev
82. AC address This address is the unique physical address that is assigned to the Ethernet LAN port IP Address The IP address that the Ethernet LAN port uses The default IP address is 192 168 1 1 DHCP Displays whether the DHCP server of the modem router is enabled for devices that are attached to the LAN Internet Port The settings of Internet port The Internet connection can run through the ADSL port with DSL service or through the WAN Ethernet port with cable or fiber service For information about how to configure the Internet settings see one of the following sections Set Up Your Modem Router for DSL Service on page 24 Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber Service on page 32 Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 MAC Address The Media Access Control MAC address This address is the unique physical address that is assigned to the Internet port IP Address The IP address that the Internet port uses If this field does not display an address or displays 0 0 0 0 as the address the modem router is not connected to the Internet Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 226 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee a ener Connection The type of Internet connection which can be a PPPoE connection PPPoA connection fixed IP address connection or DHCP con
83. ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays 5 From the WAN Preference menu select Must use Ethernet WAN By default the menu selection is Must use DSL WAN 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts Note If you use a WiFi device to connect to the modem router you might need to log in again 7 Select BASIC gt Internet The Internet Setup page displays 8 From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out 9 From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 10 Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected 11 Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the Yes radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 73 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure a cable or fiber connection with a login and PPPoE service Internet Setup GED CED GLEE Select Country USA j Select Internet Service Provider Other Internet Y Enable This Interface Use VLANID Priority 0 7 Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No m Internet Service Provider PPPoE Login guest
84. ASIC Home page displays Select Internet The Internet Setup page displays From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other From the Transfer Mode menu select ADSL ATM From the DSL Mode menu select the ADSL mode that your ISP provided you e Auto The modem router detects the DSL mode automatically This is the default setting e ADSL Legacy version of ADSL e ADSL2 Legacy version of ADSL2 e ADSL2 ADSL2 provides the fastest downstream rates and can interoperate with ADSL2 and ADSL Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected Manage the Internet Settings Manually 55 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 10 Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the Yes radio button The following figure shows the settings that display when you configure an ADSL connection with a login and PPPoE service Internet Setup GD CID ELED Select Country USA 4 Select Internet Service Provider Other X Transfer Mode ADSL ATM DSL Mode Auto X Internet Enable This Interface m Multiplexing Method LLC BASED VPI o vel 32 Use VLANID Priority 0 7
85. AnalytiCs ccceeecseeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeensaeeeeeneaas 143 Manage Wi Fi Multimedia Quality Of ServiCe eecceeeeeeeeeeeetteeeeeeeeeeeeteeneeees 144 PA EUIDeAG SIE STOMA cst os catered ens acenns ge oateatcte ds oceans tes deeedtaesdqearhecteeenmatiees 146 Improve Network Connections With Universal Plug and Play cecceeeee 146 Chapter 7 Share a Storage Device Connect an eSATA Device to the Modem Routetl cccccecseceeeeseeteeeeeeeees 149 USB Device REQUIFSMONtS aesiivcsansscercavesiccadoeivaseadee Ssensavenieneassqecbinuenereeaseeeaedene 149 Connect a USB Device to the Modem Routet cescseceeeeeseeeeeesseeeeeeeaes 149 Access a Storage Device Connected to the Modem Routet cseeeeee 150 Access the Storage Device From a Windows Compute cceeeee 150 Access the Storage Device From a Ma cccccceeeeseeceeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeenneeees 151 Back Up Windows Computers With ReadySHARE Vaull cceseeeeeeseeeeees 151 Back Up Mac Computers With Time Machine ccseeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeenneeeeees 152 Set Up a Storage Device ON a MaC ccccceccceecsseneeeeceeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeenaas 152 Prepare to Back Up a Large Amount of Datta cceeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeenneeeeetees 153 Use Time Machine to Back Up Onto a Storage DeVICE cceeeeeeteeeeeee 153 Manage Access to a Storage DeVICC cecceesceesseeeeeeeeeeseneeeeeee
86. C address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option Enter the vendor class identifier VCI string as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VCI string leave this field blank Client Identifier String option 61 Enter the client identifier client ID string as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a client ID string leave this field blank Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 63 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Specify a VDSL Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service If you want to manually configure the VDSL connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to log in and connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet To view or specify the settings for a VDSL Internet connection that requires a login and uses a PPPoE service 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3
87. CI string as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VCI string leave this field blank Client Identifier String option 61 Enter the client identifier client ID string as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a client ID string leave this field blank 12 Click the Apply button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 54 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Your settings are saved 13 Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Specify an ADSL Connection With a Login and PPPoA or PPPoE Service If you want to manually configure the ADSL connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to log in and connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet To view or specify the settings for an ADSL Internet connection that requires a login and uses a PPPoE or PPPOA service 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The B
88. Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The modem router restarts with a new IP address To reconnect close your browser relaunch it and log in to the modem router by entering http www routerlogin net When the modem router functions as a WiFi bridge you cannot change its WiFi settings that is the settings on the Wireless Settings page BASIC gt Wireless are masked out Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 256 Use VPN to Access Your Network 1 4 You can use OpenVPN software to remotely access your modem router using virtual private networking VPN This chapter explains how to set up and use VPN access The chapter includes the following sections e Set Up a VPN Connection on page 258 e Use a VPN Tunnel on a Windows Computer on page 262 e Use VPN to Access the Modem Router s USB Device and Media From a Windows Computer on page 264 e Use VPN to Access Your Internet Service at Home on page 264 257 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up a VPN Connection A virtual private network VPN lets you use the Internet to securely access your network when you are not home This type of VPN access is called a client to gateway tunnel The computer is the client and the modem router is the gateway To use the VPN feature you must log in to the modem router and enable VPN and you must install and run VPN client software on the computer Note The modem router does not support iOS or Andr
89. Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Apply gt Network Device Name o0 C Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port e Network Neighborhood MacShare 07800 Vv HTTP http readyshare routerlogin nevshares 80 F HTTP via internet 192 168 100 1 har 443 ia FIP ftp readyshare routerlogin nevshares 21 F FTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space WD7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgear com Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router In the Available Network Folders table select a device Click the Safely Remove USB Device button The device goes offline and a pop up window opens Share a Storage Device 165 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 7 Click the OK button 8 Physically disconnect the USB device Share a Storage Device 166
90. Fi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Bs eea Enable 20 40 MHz By default 20 40 MHz coexistence is enabled to prevent interference between WiFi networks Coexistence in your environment at the expense of the WiFi speed If no other WiFi networks are present in your environment you can clear the Enable 20 40 MHz Coexistence check box to increase the WiFi speed to the maximum supported speed Note This setting applies to the 2 4 GHz band only CTS RTS Threshold 1 2347 The CTS RTS threshold the default is 2347 and the preamble mode the default is Automatic are reserved for WiFi testing and advanced configuration only Do not change these settings unless directed by NETGEAR support or unless you are sure what the consequences are Incorrect settings might disable the WiFi function of the modem router unexpectedly Preamble Mode Transmit Power Control You can lower the WiFi transmit power by selecting a value lower than 100 from the Transmit Power Control menu The setting of 100 allows the modem router to use the maximum WiFi transmit power to transmit WiFi packets Reducing the transmit power can save the power consumption for the modem router but also reduces the WiFi coverage If you want to ensure maximum WiFi coverage we recommend that you leave the setting on the Transmit Power Conirol menu at 100 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up the Modem Router as a WiFi Access Point Only By default th
91. Fi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Traffic Meter The Traffic Meter page displays In the Traffic Control section clear the Disconnect and disable the Internet connection check box Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts Manage the Modem Router Remotely The remote management feature lets you access your modem router securely over the Internet to view or change its settings You must know the modem router s WAN IP address to use this feature For information about a different Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 243 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 type of remote access that is remote access using Dynamic DNS see Access Storage Devices Through the Internet on page 172 Noie Be sure to change the password for the user name admin to a secure password The ideal password contains no dictionary words from any language and contains uppercase and lowercase letters numbers and symbols It can be up to 30 characters See Change the admin Password on page 40 To set up remote management 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected
92. GEAR product and contact NETGEAR technical support When the modem router connects to the Internet you are prompted to download and install the free NETGEAR Desktop genie app and the free ReadySHARE Vault app Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection You can view or change the modem router s ADSL Internet connection settings manually The following sections describe the options that are available to you to manually set up the ADSL Internet connection e Specify an ADSL Connection Without a Login on page 50 e Specify an ADSL Connection With a Login and PPPoA or PPPoE Service on page 55 Note Some ISPs require that you register on their website before you can obtain Internet service Follow the directions that your ISP gave you Specify an ADSL Connection Without a Login If you want to manually configure the ADSL connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet Note Some ISPs support two virtual interfaces one Internet virtual interface and one IPTV virtual interface Before you specify the settings for the IPTV interface first use the following procedure to specify the settings for the Internet interface Then repeat the procedure to specify the settings for the IPTV interface While doing so follow the directions that your ISP gave you
93. ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 If you are specifying the settings for the virtual IPTV interface and your ISP informed you that you must use bridge mode select the Bridge Mode check box For more information about bridge mode see Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV Devices on page 192 Enter the account name as indicated by your ISP This name might also be called the host name If your ISP did not provide you with an account name or host name leave the default setting Enter the domain name as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a domain name leave this field blank Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Manage the Internet Settings Manually 53 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e n Use Static IP Address Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Use IP over ATM IPoA Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP ad
94. LED is off the WiFi radios are turned off and you cannot use WiFi to connect to the modem router For more information see Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 and Troubleshoot With the LEDs on page 284 WPS button with WPS LED This button lets you use WPS to join the WiFi network without typing the WiFi password The WPS LED blinks white during this process and then lights solid white For more information see Use WPS to Add a Device to the WiFi Network on page 108 You can use the LED On Off switch on the back panel of the modem router to turn most LEDs on the top of the modem router on or off see Back Panel With Ports Buttons Connectors and Switch on page 15 If you turn off the LEDs the Power LED remains on Back Panel With Ports Buttons Connectors and Switch The back panel of the modem router provides ports buttons antenna connectors a DC power connector and an LED switch For information about attaching the antennas see Attach the Antennas on page 11 Figure 3 Modem router back panel Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 15 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In addition to the antennas viewed from left to right the back panel contains the following components LED Off On switch Move the LED Off On switch to to the Off position to turn off all LEDs except for the Power LED Reset button For information about using the Reset button see Use the Reset Button on page
95. Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage 8 Devices Through the Internet With Dynamic DNS you can use the Internet and a personal domain name to access a USB storage device that is attached to a USB port on the modem router when you are not home If you know the IP address of the modem router and the IP address did not change you can also access the USB storage device by using the IP address This chapter includes the following sections e Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS on page 168 e Access Storage Devices Through the Internet on page 172 Note For information about how to connect the device and specify its settings see Share a Storage Device on page 148 167 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS Internet service providers ISPs assign numbers called IP addresses to identify each Internet account Most ISPs use dynamically assigned IP addresses This means that the IP address can change at any time You can use the IP address to access your network remotely but most people do not know what their IP address is or when this address changes To make it easier to connect you can get a free account with a Dynamic DNS service that lets you use a domain name to access your home network To use this account you must set up the modem router to use Dynamic DNS Then the modem router notifies the Dynamic DNS service provider whenever its IP address changes When you access your Dynamic DNS a
96. Manually connected by another computer click the Disconnect button The printer is released from the connection and the status changes to Available 3 To print from your computer when the status shows Waiting to Connect do the following a Click the Connect button The printer status changes to Manually connected by Mycomputer Now only your computer can use the printer b To allow the printer to be shared click the Disconnect button The printer is released from the connection and the status changes to Available Use the Scan Feature of a Multifunction USB Printer If your USB printer supports scanning you can also use the USB printer for scanning For example the USB printer displayed in the Windows Printers and Faxes window is ready for print jobs Share a USB Printer 187 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 amp Printers and Faxes File Edit View Favorites Tools Help e B Search Folders E Address Printers and Faxes L O HP Photosmart C5200 series Printer Tasks 0 Paused E Add a printer Set up faxing See Also 2 Troubleshoot printing Get help with printing Other Places To use the scan feature of a multifunction USB printer 1 Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon pe I NETGEAR USB Control Center System Tools About Device Status Make sure that the printer status shows as Available Click the Network Scann
97. NETGEAR Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router User Manual Model D7800 September 2015 202 11572 01 350 E Plumeria Drive San Jose CA 95134 USA Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Support Thank you for purchasing this NETGEAR product You can visit www netgear com support to register your product get help access the latest downloads and user manuals and join our community We recommend that you use only official NETGEAR support resources Conformity For the current EU Declaration of Conformity visit http kb netgear com app answers detail a_id 11621 Compliance For regulatory compliance information visit http www netgear com about regulatory See the regulatory compliance document before connecting the power supply Trademarks NETGEAR Inc NETGEAR and the NETGEAR Logo are trademarks of NETGEAR Inc Any non NETGEAR trademarks are used for reference purposes only Contents Chapter 1 Hardware Overview of the Modem Router Unpack Your Modem FOutet ss sci ccecses sezecesnccasaneadestcesndeacidennss seaeaneethacarsescisboneds 11 Attach the AnteninaS 0 ccccccccccccccccecsceseceeeseeeeseseueuaeeeeeeueeeeueeuaeeeenenaeeeananaeeeasanes 11 Ho em geal Mp With hl cB cee eer eee nee eee eee eee 12 Back Panel With Ports Buttons Connectors and SWiItch cccccescssseeseeeeees 15 USB Ports on the Left Panel cece ccsceececesseeeeseseeeeeseseeeaesueeseae
98. OUN You re about to setup NETGEAR Live Parental Controls Powered by OpenDNS on your router to fiter websites visited on your computers and other networked devices THE INTERNET UVE PARENTAL CONTROLS ENABLED v Set different filtering rules for each user on your network v Set rules based on the time of day FILTERING LOW Our custom settings let you relax security settings for some users or at some times of the day Learn more 8 Click the Next button read the note and click the Next button again Control Access to the Internet 118 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Because Live Parental Controls uses free OpenDNS accounts you are prompted to log in or create a free account Setting up Live Parental Controls Welcome this setup wizard will quiddy configure NETGEAR Live Parental Controls Powered by OpenDNS on your NETGEAR router In order to use Live Parental Controls you need a free OpenDNS account Do you already have one Yes use my existing OpenDNS account O No I need to create a free OpenDNS account 9 Select a radio button as follows e If you already own an OpenDNS account leave the Yes radio button selected e If you do not own an OpenDNS account select the No radio button If you are creating an account the Create a free OpenDNS account page displays Do the following a Complete the fields b Click the Next button After you log on or create your account
99. Password Service Name lf Required Connection Mode Always On Idle Timeout in Minutes Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address a0 63 91 7a 14 99 12 Enter the cable or fiber settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 74 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ns Use VLANID Select the Use VLANID check box and enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP AVLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting Priority 0 7 If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 From the menu select PPPoE for a PPP over Ethernet connection Internet Service Provider Login Enter the login name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP This login name is often an email address Enter the password th
100. PoA Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for IPoA service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Manage the Internet Settings Manually 62 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e beea S Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address Use These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If secondary and tertiary DNS server addresses are available enter them also Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MA
101. SL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Ss Sa Figure 14 Bridge mode setup with an 802 11ac WiFi connection Setting up a WiFi bridge with two modem routers offers the following benefits e You can take advantage of gigabit WiFi speeds on current devices e Use gigabit WiFi for applications such as video and gaming e Connect multiple devices such as a NAS Smart TV NeoTV Blu ray player and game consoles at gigabit WiFi speeds using a WiFi link e Avoid the need for separate WiFi adapters for each device For example you could install the first modem router in a room such as a home office where your Internet connection is located Then set up the second modem router as a WiFi bridge and place it in a different room such as the room where your home entertainment center is located Cable the modem router that functions as a WiFi bridge to your Smart TV DVR game console or Blu ray player and use its 802 11ac WiFi connection to the first modem router The modem router that is connected to the Internet modem does not require any special setup because the modem router that functions as a WiFi bridge connects to an existing SSID as a WiFi client just like any other WiFi clients To set up a modem router as a WiFi bridge 1 Make a note of the WiFi settings of the other modem router that is connected to the Internet modem You must know the SSID WiFi security mode WiFi password and operating frequency either 2
102. Specify which devices on your LAN or LAN users are affected by the rule based on their IP addresses e Only This IP Address Enter the required address in the fields to apply the rule to a single device on your LAN IP Address Range Enter the required addresses in the start and end fields to apply the rule to a range of devices All IP Addresses All computers and devices on your LAN are covered by this rule By default the All IP Addresses radio button is selected 9 Click the Add button The new rule is added to the Service Table on the Block Services page Add an Outbound Firewall Rule for a Custom Service or Application The modem router lists many default services and applications that you can use in outbound rules If the service or application is not predefined you can specify a custom service or application in an outbound rule Control Access to the Internet 130 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To add an outbound firewall rule for a custom service or application 1 Find out which protocol and port number or range of numbers the service or application uses You can usually find this information by contacting the publisher of the service or application or through online user or news groups Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter modem router the user name and passw
103. Upa VPN COMMBCHOM vassssies iiecasswcatiaxinnss mriaeccase A RR 258 Specify VPN Service in the Modem RoOute cccccccssssseseeceeeeeeeesseeeaaes 258 Install OpenVPN Software on a Windows Computet eeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 259 Install OpenVPN Software on a Mac Computet cc ccceceeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeee 261 Use a VPN Tunnel on a Windows Computel cccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeees 262 Use VPN to Access the Modem Router s USB Device and Media From a Windows COMPUTE sonra cucpaanapttaercencdstadasceckenasntionnsaieceneecnadeeiaccarnee ienagioetnasdanenmadoicanene 264 Use VPN to Access Your Internet Service at HOME cccccceeesesstteeeeeeeeeees 264 Set Up VPN Client Internet Access in the Modem Routet 0000 264 Block VPN Client Internet Access in the Modem Route ccccceeeee 265 Use a VPN Tunnel to Access Your Internet Service at Home cceee 266 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Chapter 15 Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering Manage Port Forwarding to a Local Server for Services and Applications 268 Forward Incoming Traffic for a Default Service or Application 008 268 Add a Port Forwarding Rule With a Custom Service or Application 269 Change a Port Forwarding Rule wicsiccecsssicstenssensccatavcctteensseeeatereseneceasaceanewes 271 Remove a Port Forwarding RUC sicsis nsmnnteneaieit
104. VPN Client Internet Access in the Modem Router By default the modem router is set up to allow VPN connections only to your home network but you can change the setting to allow Internet access Accessing the Internet remotely through a VPN might be slower than accessing the Internet directly Use VPN to Access Your Network 264 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To allow VPN clients to use your home Internet service 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VPN Service The VPN page displays Select the Enable VPN Service radio button Scroll down to the Clients will use this VPN connection to access section and select the All sites on the Internet amp Home Network radio button When you access the Internet with the VPN connection instead of using a local Internet service you use the Internet service from your home network Note By default the Auto radio button is selected which lets the modem router use an automatic detection system that enables VPN access only for necessary services and sites and might not include full Internet access Click the Apply butto
105. WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Sites The Block Sites page displays In the Block sites containing these keywords or domain names field select the keyword or domain Click the Delete Keyword button The keyword or domain is removed from the blocked list Click the Apply button Control Access to the Internet 126 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Your settings are saved Remove All Keywords and Domains From the Blocked List You can simultaneously remove all keywords and domains from the blocked list To remove all keywords and domains from the blocked list 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Sites The Block Sites page displays Click the Clear List button All keywords and domains are removed from the blocked list Click the Apply button Your settin
106. Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 5GHz Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 5G Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 Print this e Take me to the Internet Only if you are using a DSL connection and the following page displays Specify a full scan to let the Setup Wizard find the PVC protocol The page that might display asks you if you need the Setup Wizard to do a full scan to find the PVC protocol If this page does not display continue with Step 10 Do you need Setup Wizard to do full scan to find the PVC Protocol Yes This will take approximotely 1 to 6 minutes No want to configure the router myself Do the following Manage the Internet Settings Manually 46 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Select the Yes radio button b Click the Next button The Setup Wizard performs a full scan which might take up to six minutes This takes approximately 1 to 6 minutes gt T a 10 Only if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the Internet connection The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection If this page does not display continue with Step 11 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection This is most likely due to one of the following reasons on To power cycle a modem with batte
107. a 32 character maximum case sensitive name in this field Channel From the Channel menu select an individual channel The default channel depends on your selection from the Region menu Note In some regions not all channels are available Do not change the channel unless you experience interference shown by lost connections or slow data transfers If this situation occurs experiment with different channels to see which is the best Note If you use multiple WiFi access points APs reduce interference by selecting different channels for adjacent APs We recommend a channel spacing of four channels between adjacent APs Mode From the Mode menu select one of the following modes e Up to 347 Mbps Legacy mode This mode allows 802 11ac 802 11n and 802 11a devices to join the network but limits 802 11ac and 802 11n devices to functioning at up to 347 Mbps Up to 800 Mbps Neighbor friendly mode for reduced interference with neighboring WiFi networks This mode allows 802 11ac 802 11n and 802 11a devices to join the network but limits 802 11ac devices to functioning at up to 800 Mbps Up to 1733 Mbps Performance mode This mode allows 802 11ac 802 11n and 802 11a devices to join the network and allows 802 11ac devices to function at up to 1733 Mbps This mode is the default mode Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 102 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Se es Security Options This informati
108. a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Services Block Services CCZ GEL mE Services Blocking Never Per Schedule Always Service Table 2 Service Type Port IP In the Services Blocking section specify how the modem router applies outbound rules e Per Schedule Use keyword blocking according to a schedule that you set For more information see Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules on page 134 e Always Use keyword blocking continuously Control Access to the Internet 129 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 6 Below the Service Table click the Add button CEID EED Service Type User Defined v Protocol TCP z Starting Port 1 65535 Ending Port 1 65535 Service Type User Defined Filter Services For Only This IP Address 192 168 1 IP Address Range 192 l168 ll1 AJl IP Addresses 7 From the Service Type menu select service or application to be covered by this rule If the service or application does not display in the list you can add it see Add an Outbound Firewall Rule for a Custom Service or Application on page 130 8
109. ad the OpenVPN client utility for Mac OS X visit code google com p tunnelblick Download and install the file Unzip the configuration files that you downloaded in Step 6 and copy them to the folder in which the OpenVPN client utility is installed on your computer The client utility must be installed by a user with administrative privileges For more information about using OpenVPN on a Mac computer visit openvpn net index php access server docs admin guides 183 how to connect to access server from a mac html Use a VPN Tunnel on a Windows Computer After you set up the modem router to use VPN and install the OpenVPN application on your computer you can open a VPN tunnel from your computer to your modem router over the Internet For the VPN tunnel to work the local LAN IP address of the remote router must use a different LAN IP scheme from that of the local LAN where your VPN client computer is connected If both networks use the same LAN IP scheme when the VPN tunnel is established you cannot access your home router or your home network with the OpenVPN software The default LAN IP address scheme for the modem router is 192 x x x The most common IP schemes are 192 x x x 172 x x x and 10 x x x If you experience a conflict change the IP scheme either for your home network or for the network with the client VPN computer For information about changing these settings see Manage the Modem Router s LAN IP Address Settings on page 20
110. ame o0 C Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port 0 Network Neighborhood MacShare 07800 V HTTP http readyshare routerlogin netshares 80 HTTP via internet 192 168 100 1 har 443 w FTP ftp readyshare routerlogin nevshares 21 FTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space WO7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgearcom Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router 5 The Available Networks Folder section shows the following settings e Share Name The default share name is USB_ Storage e Read Access and Write Access The permissions and access controls on the network folder All no password the default allows all users to access the network folder The password for admin is the same one that you use to log in to the modem router e Folder Name Full path of the network folder Volume Name Volume name from the storage device Total Space and Free Space The current utilization of the storage device Add a Network Folder on a Storage Device You can add network folders on a storage device connected to the USB port on the modem router te To add a network folder 1 L
111. anage the DHCP Server Address Pool on page 207 e Manage Reserved LAN IP Addresses on page 208 e Disable the Built In DHCP Server on page 210 e Change the Modem Router s Device Name on page 211 e Set Up and Manage Custom Static Routes on page 212 191 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Change the Physical WAN Connection Preference The modem router can autodetect the type of WAN connection However you can also set the WAN connection preference manually to either the DSL port or the Ethernet WAN port Note The modem router does not support load balancing over DSL and Ethernet WAN interfaces Only one WAN interface either the DLS port or the Ethernet WAN port can be active at any time t To change the WAN connection preference 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays From the WAN Preference menu select one of the following options e Must use DSL WAN The modem router uses the DSL port for a DSL WAN connection The Internet port is shut down e Must use Ethernet WAN The modem router uses the Internet port for an Ethernet WAN conn
112. anced Setup gt Wireless Settings Technical Specifications Table 6 D7800 modem router specifications Data and routing protocols TCP IP RIP 1 RIP 2 DHCP PPPoE PPPoA PPTP L2TP Dynamic DNS UPnP and SMB North America 120V 60 Hz input Power adapter UK Australia 240V 50 Hz input Europe 230V 50 Hz input All regions 12V 3 5A output 90 maximum relative humidity noncondensing Supplemental Information 297 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee reer ei e EN 55022 2010 AC 2011 Class B Electromagnetic emissions e CISPR 22 2008 Class B e AS NZS CISPR 22 2009 Amadt 1 2010 Class B One RJ 11 asynchronous DSL ADSL VDSL port lt Maximum WiFi signal rate complies with the IEEE 802 11 standard Note Throughput can vary Network conditions and environmental factors including volume of network traffic building materials and construction and network overhead affect the data throughput rate Radio data rates Auto rate sensing e 2 11ac 2 Data encoding standards epee ace e IEEE 802 11n version 2 0 e EEE 802 11n 256QAM IEEE 802 11g IEEE 802 11b 2 4 GHz IEEE 802 11n IEEE 802 11a 5 0 GHz Maximum computers per WiFi network Limited by the amount of WiFi network traffic generated by each node typically 50 70 nodes Supplemental Information 298 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 2 4 GHz band Operating frequ
113. assword if it is forgotten This recovery process is supported in Internet Explorer Firefox and Chrome browsers but not in the Safari browser To set up password recovery 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Set Password The Set Password page displays Select the Enable Password Recovery check box Select two security questions and provide answers to them Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 41 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Let the Modem Router Automatically Update Its Firmware When you set up your modem router and are connected to the Internet the modem router automatically checks for you to see if newer firmware is available If it is a message is displayed at the top of the page For information about manually upgrading firmware see Update the Firmware of the Modem Router on page 217 To let the modem router automatically update its firmware 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net
114. at are sent between the IPTV device and the modem router s Internet port from being processed through the modem router s network address translation NAT service You can add VLAN tag groups to a bridge and assign VLAN IDs and priority values to each VLAN tag group To add a VLAN tag group and enable the bridge 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 199 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VLAN Bridge Seitings The VLAN Bridge Settings page displays Select the Enable VLAN Bridge Group check box VLAN Bridge Settings x cance GLEE V Enable VLAN Bridge group By bridge group By VLAN tag group Enable Name VLAN ID Priority Wired Ports Wireless Internet All All Select the By VLAN tag group radio button Add Vian Rule cx Name VLAN ID 1 4094 Priority 0 7 E Porti E Port2 E Ports Ports O wiri 2 4 El WiFi 5G 7 Specify the settings as described in the following table Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 200 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enter a
115. at you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Service Name If Required Enter the service name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Often a service name is not required Connection Mode Select how the Internet connection functions e Always On Once the Internet connection is established it remains active This is the default setting Dial on Demand When someone attempts to connect to the Internet the Internet connection is established When the idle time out period expires the Internet connection is terminated Manually Connect You must connect to the Internet manually see View Establish or Terminate the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet Connection on page 232 Idle Timeout In Minutes If you select Dial on Demand from the Connection Mode menu enter the idle time out period in minutes The idle time out specifies how long the modem router keeps the Internet connection active when no one on the network is using the Internet connection The default is 5 minutes To disable the idle time out enter 0 When you disable the idle time out the connection is not terminated automatically Internet IP Address Manage the Internet Settings Manually 75 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee bea S Get Dynamically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Use Static IP Ad
116. aunch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays In the Internet Port pane click the Show Statistics button The Show Statistics pop up window opens The following table describes the fields and columns of the Show Statistics pop up window System Up Time The time elapsed since the modem router was last restarted Port The statistics for the WAN Internet over Ethernet port LAN Ethernet ports WLAN b g n port and WLAN a n ac port For each port the page cane the information that is described in this table The link status of the port TxPkts The number of packets that were transmitted on this port since reset or manual clear RxPkts The number of packets that were received on this port since reset or manual clear Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 229 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 RS Collisions The number of packets that collided on this port since reset or manual clear The number of bytes per second that were transmitted on this port since reset or manual clear Rx B s The number of bytes per second that were received on this
117. aunch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Share a Storage Device 159 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings GLC GEL Network Device Name 07800 Wa Edit Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port T Network Neighborhood MacShare 107800 V HTTP httpreadyshare routerlogin nevshares 80 E HTTP via internet 192 168 1 har 443 T FTP fip readyshare routerlogin netshares 21 F FTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space WO7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Create Network Folder Edit Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgear com Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router 5 Inthe Available Network Folders table select a device Share a Storage Device 160 10 11 12 13 1
118. aved for the virtual Internet interface Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 196 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 6 From the menu above the Enable This Interface check box select IPTV Setup Select Country Germany lt Select Internet Service Provider Deutsche Telekom v Transfer Mode VOSL PTM v7 DSL Mode VDSL2 v m IPTV hd V Enable This Interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED VPI VCI Use VLANID e Priority 0 7 is Bridge Mode The previous figure shows only the top of the Internet Setup page 7 Configure a VLAN for the virtual IPTV interface a Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected for the virtual IPTV interface If you already enabled and configured the virtual IPTV interface the check box is selected b Select the Use VLANID check box c Enter a VLAN ID that applies to the virtual IPTV interface The VLAN ID can be in a range from 0 to 4094 The default VLAN ID is 0 d To specify a priority for the VLAN in the Priority 0 7 field enter a value from 0 to 7 e Click the Apply button Your settings are saved for the virtual IPTV interface Note For information about enabling bridge mode for the IPTV virtual interface see Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV Devices on page 192 Set Up a Bridge for a Port Group or VLAN Tag Group Some devices such as an IPTV cannot function behind the modem router s network address translation NAT ser
119. awk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection If this page does not display continue with Step 17 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection This is most likely due to one of the following reasons U N None of the above P A corrected a problem with the DSL Ethemet cable Take one of the following actions e If you did not yet power cycle the modem do so now a oap gt Q Unplug your modem s power leaving the modem connected to the wall jack for your Internet service If your modem includes a battery backup remove the battery Wait 10 seconds If your modem includes a battery backup reinsert the battery Plug in your modem s power and turn on your modem Wait two minutes Select the I just power cycled the modem and waited for 2 minutes radio button Click the Next button e See if the Ethernet cable is not fully inserted or is inserted at the wrong place If necessary do the following a b C Fully insert the Ethernet cable in the correct port on the modem and in the red Internet port on the modem router Select the I corrected a problem with the DSL Ethernet cable radio button Click the Next button e If you do not need to power cycle the modem or the Ethernet cable is already fully inserted in the correct ports do the following a
120. beamforming 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Wireless Settings The Advanced Wireless Settings page displays Scroll to the very bottom of the page Disable or enable beamforming by doing the following e To disable beamforming clear the Enable BEAMFORMING check box e To enable beamforming select the Enable BEAMFORMING check box By default implicit beamforming is enabled 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Improve Network Connections With Universal Plug and Play Universal Plug and Play UPnP helps devices such as Internet appliances and computers access the network and connect to other devices as needed UPnP devices can automatically discover the services from other registered UPnP devices on the network Optimize Performance 146 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you use applications such as multiplayer gaming peer to peer connections or real time communications such as instant messaging or remote assistance keep UPnP enabled which it is by default To manage Universal Plug and Play 1 2 Launch a web browser from a
121. ber and MAC address of the modem router Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 17 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 NETGEAR Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 WiFi Network Name SSID SERIAL Designed by NETGEAR C ON c US LISTED ITE E212778 Ruz Password Network Key MAC FCC ID XXXXXXXXXXX O C XXXXK XXXKXXKK 4 US 200000000000XX a Taea mu ROUTER LOGIN BE http www routerlogin net username admin password password PTO XXX XX XXX ee ReadyShore Access on Windows Start Run readyshare Figure 6 Modem router product label Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 18 Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network This chapter describes how you can install and access the modem router and its network The chapter contains the following sections Position Your Modem Router on page 20 Connect to the Modem Router on page 21 Set Up Your Modem Router for DSL Service on page 24 Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber Service on page 32 Log In to the Modem Router After Setup to View or Change Settings on page 38 Change the Language on page 40 Change the admin Password on page 40 Set Up Password Recovery on page 41 Let the Modem Router Automatically Update Its Firmware on page 42 Access the Modem Router With the NETGEAR genie App on page 42 19 2 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Mo
122. ber Internet service 1 Maximum WiFi signal rate derived from IEEE standard 802 11 specifications Actual data throughput and WiFi coverage will vary Network conditions and environmental factors including volume of network traffic building materials and construction and network overhead lower actual data throughput rate and WiFi coverage NETGEAR makes no express or implied representations or warranties about this product s compatibility with any future standards 802 1 1ac 1733 Mbps is approximately 4x faster than 802 11n 450 Mbps 2 The 2 4 GHz performance mode requires 256 QAM support on the WiFi client 3 Up to 1733 Mbps WiFi speeds can be achieved when you are connecting to other 802 11ac 1733 Mbps devices This chapter contains the following sections e Unpack Your Modem Router on page 11 e Attach the Antennas on page 11 e Top Panel With LEDs on page 12 e Back Panel With Ports Buttons Connectors and Switch on page 15 e USB Ports on the Left Panel on page 16 e eSATA Port on the Right Panel on page 16 e Connect an eSATA Device on page 17 Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 Note For more information about the topics that are covered in this manual visit the support website at support netgear com Note Firmware updates with new features and bug fixes are made available from time to time at downloadcenter netgear com You can check for and download new firmware manually If the features or behavior of your product d
123. both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting Priority 0 7 If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 VP VC You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 Bridge Mode If you are specifying the settings for the virtual IPTV interface and your ISP informed you that you must use bridge mode select the Bridge Mode check box For more information about bridge mode see Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV Devices on page 192 IPTV interface only Account Name Enter the account name as indicated by your ISP This name might also be called the host name If your ISP did not provide you with an account name or host name leave the default setting Domain Name Enter the domain name as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a domain name leave this field blank Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Use Static IP Address Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Use IP over ATM I
124. c is detected Disable blinking on Internet LED LAN LED Wireless LED USB LED and eSATA LED when data traffic is detected Turn off all LEDs except Power LED By default the first radio button is selected which allows standard LED behavior For more information about LEDs see Top Panel With LEDs on page 12 To disable blinking select the Disable blinking on Internet LED LAN LED Wireless LED USB LED and eSATA LED when data traffic is detected radio button To turn off all LEDs except the Power LED select the Turn off all LEDs except Power LED radio button Click the Apply button Your settings are saved View the Status and Statistics of the Modem Router You can view information about the modem router and its ports and the status of the Internet connection and WiFi network In addition you can view traffic statistics for the various ports View Information About the Modem Router and the Internet and WiFi Settings You can view modem router information the Internet port status and WiFi settings t To view information about the modem router and the Internet modem and WiFi settings 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive Manage the Modem Router and Moni
125. case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Traffic Meter Traffic Meter CCZ ENE Internet Traffic Meter Enable Traffic Meter Traffic volume control by No limit Monthly limit 0 Mbytes Round up data volume for each connection by 0 Mbytes Connection time control Monthly limit 0 Hours Traffic Counter Restart traffic counter at 0 00 am On the ist day of each month Restart Counter Now Traffic Control Pop up a warning message 0 Mbytes Minutes before the monthly limit is reached When the monthly limit is reached Turn the Internet LED to flashing white amber Disconnect and disable the Internet connection Select the Enable Traffic Meter check box Select the Traffic volume control by radio button From the corresponding menu select an option e Download only The restriction is applied to incoming traffic only Both Directions The restriction is applied to both incoming and outgoing traffic In the Monthly Limit field enter how many MBytes MB per month are allowed If your ISP charges you for extra data volume when you make a new connection enter the extra data volume in MB in the Round up data volume for each connection by field 10 In the Traffic Counter section set the traffic counter to begin at a specific time and date Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 240 11 12 13 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In t
126. ccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeesenaeeeeneeas 187 Use the Scan Feature of a Multifunction USB Printer 0 cceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 187 Manage the NETGEAR USB Control Center SettingS c ceeeeeeeeeeees 189 Turn Off Automatic Startup of the NETGEAR USB Control Center 189 Change the NETGEAR USB Control Center Language c ceeeeee 190 Specify the TNS OU ecgsscccs seeder cacecateedcceeaviebioteeendes aexenisimiiueetdolaadauenieamaiaieeee 190 Chapter 11 Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings Change the Physical WAN Connection Preference ccceceseceeeeeeeteeeeeeeees 192 Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV DeViCeS ccceeesceeeeeeceeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaeeeees 192 Enable and Configure a ard Cee en ee eee nee eee eee 194 Set Up a Bridge for a Port Group or VLAN Tag Group ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeee 197 Set Up a Bridge for a Port GrOup ccccceeeescceeeeeseaeeeeeesnaeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaeeeeee 198 Set Up a Bridge for a VLAN Tag Group ecccceeeessceeeeeseeeteeeseeeeeeeeaeeeeeee 199 Manage the WAN Security SettingS cccceceeeseeceeeeeeceeeeesaaeeeeeeseeeenenseeees 201 Set Up a Default DMZ Server eee ecccceeeeeeeceeeeeeceaeeeeeeneeeeeeeaaeeeeeesaaeeeeeseaas 202 Manage IGMP Proxy itn ic fice csccads vet cnades cecdscacs sncazecs Sechananienicadeustaceacdatrvadanstoacs 203 Manage NAT Fiber inG assess neesssetedecass oncecariaseninisatnncea navateeeaiatanegetneena
127. ccount the service finds the current IP address of your home network and automatically connects you If your ISP assigns a private WAN IP address such as 192 168 x x or 10 x x x the Dynamic DNS service does not work because private addresses are not routed on the Internet Your Personal FTP Server With your customized free URL you can use FTP to access your network when you are not home through Dynamic DNS To set up your FTP server you must register for a NETGEAR Dynamic DNS DDNS service account and specify the account settings r y ha A FTP Directory E FTPY custom name mynetgear com h Figure 12 You can access your network through the Internet when you re not home Note The modem router supports only basic DDNS and the login and password might not be secure You can use DDNS with a VPN tunnel for a secure connection Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 168 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To set up your personal account and use FTP 1 Get your NETGEAR Dynamic DNS domain name For more information see Set Up a New Dynamic DNS Account on page 169 Make sure that your Internet connection is working Your modem router must use a direct Internet connection It cannot connect to a different router to access the Internet Connect a storage device the modem router You can connect an eSATA device to the eSATA port and you can conne
128. ce or application Service User From the Service User menu select Any or select Single address and enter the IP address of one computer e Any This is the default setting and allows any computer on the Internet to use this service e Single address Restricts the service to a particular computer Service Type Select the protocol TCP or UDP that is associated with the service or application Triggering Port Enter the number of the outbound traffic port that must open the inbound ports Inbound Connection Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 275 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ez i Connection Type Select the protocol TCP or UDP that is associated with the inbound connection If you are unsure select TCP UDP Starting Port Enter the start port number for the inbound connection Ending Port Enter the end port number for the inbound connection Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the rule is added to the Port Triggering Portmap Table on the Port Forwarding Port Triggering page Change a Port Triggering Rule You can change an existing port triggering rule To change a port triggering rule 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The
129. ch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Media Server The Media Server Settings page displays Make sure that the Enable TiVo support check box is selected If you changed the setting click the Apply button Your settings are saved Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 180 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Play Videos To play videos 1 On the TiVo select TiVo Central gt My Shows 2 Go to the bottom of the list and select the D7800 Play Music or View Photos To play music or view photos 1 On the TiVo select TiVo Central gt Music Photos amp Showcases Showcases 2 Select an item to play or watch Copy TiVo Files to a Computer To copy TiVo files to a computer e Use the TiVo Desktop accessory available at https vww3 tivo com store accessories software do Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 181 Share a USB Printer 1 0 The ReadySHARE Printer utility lets you share a USB printer that is connected to the USB port on your modem router You can share this USB printer among the Windows and Mac computers on your network This c
130. ck Services CCZ ELEL Services Blocking Never Per Schedule Always Service Table Service Type Port IP 1 Age of Empire 47624 47624 all 2 Quakell lll 27960 27960 192 168 1 100 192 168 1 199 The previous figure shows two rules in the Service Table In the Service Table select the radio button for the rule Click the Edit button The Block Services Setup page displays Change the settings For more information about the settings see Add an Outbound Firewall Rule for a Custom Service or Application on page 130 Click the Accept button Your settings are saved The changed rule displays in the Service Table on the Block Services page Control Access to the Internet 133 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Remove an Outbound Firewall Rule You can remove an outbound firewall rule that you no longer need To remove an outbound firewall rule 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Services Block Services ee ELE Services Blocking Never Per Schedule Always Service Table a Service Type Port IP 1 Age of Empire 47624 47624 all 2 Quakel
131. computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt UPnP The UPnP page displays Select the Turn UPnP On check box By default this check box is selected You can disable or enable UPnP for automatic device configuration If the Turn UPnP On check box is cleared the modem router does not allow any device to automatically control router resources such as port forwarding Enter the advertisement period in minutes The advertisement period specifies how often the modem router broadcasts its UPnP information This value can range from 1 to 1440 minutes The default period is 30 minutes Shorter durations ensure that control points detect current device status at the expense of more network traffic Longer durations can compromise the freshness of the device status but can significantly reduce network traffic Enter the advertisement time to live in hops The time to live for the advertisement is measured in hops steps for each UPnP packet sent Hops are the steps a packet takes between routers The number of hops can range from 1 to 255 The default value for the advertisement time to live is 4 hops which should be fine for most home networks If you
132. ct USB storage devices to the USB ports on the modem router If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the modem router When you connect the storage device to the modem router s port it might take up to two minutes before the storage device is ready for sharing By default the device is available to all computers on your local area network LAN Set up FTP access on the modem router For more information see Set Up FTP Access Through the Internet on page 173 On a remote computer with Internet access you can use FTP to access your modem router using ftp yourname mynetgear com in which yourname is your specific domain name For more information see Use FTP to Access Storage Devices Through the Internet on page 174 Set Up a New Dynamic DNS Account NETGEAR offers you the opportunity to set up and register for a free Dynamic DNS account To set up Dynamic DNS and register for a free NETGEAR account 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 169 CS Sg 9 10 11 Nighthawk X
133. ct an RIP direction Both The modem router broadcasts its routing table periodically and incorporates information that it receives This is the default setting Out Only The modem router broadcasts its routing table periodically but does not incorporate the RIP information that it receives e In Only The modem router incorporates the RIP information that it receives but does not broadcast its routing table From the RIP Version menu select an RIP version e Disabled The RIP version is disabled This is the default setting e RIP 1 This format is universally supported It is adequate for most networks unless you are using an unusual network setup RIP 2 This format carries more information Both RIP 2B and RIP 2M send the routing data in RIP 2 format RIP 2B uses subnet broadcasting RIP 2M uses multicasting Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 206 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manage the DHCP Server Address Pool By default the modem router acts as a Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol DHCP server The modem router assigns IP DNS server and default gateway addresses to all computers that are connected to its LAN and WiFi network The assigned default gateway address is the LAN address of the modem router These addresses must be part of the same IP address subnet as the modem router s LAN IP address The default DHCP addr
134. cted to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 170 10 11 12 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Settings gt Dynamic DNS Dynamic DNS f J _ Use a Dynamic DNS Service Service Provider NETGEAR Do you have a NETGEAR DDNS or a No IP DDNS account Yes 2 No Please enter the following information for registration Host Name mynetgear com Email Password 6 32 characters Register By submitting this form agree to the terms of service and that I will only create one free account Select the Use a Dynamic DNS Service check box From the Service Provider menu select your provider Select the Yes radio button Dynamic DNS V Use a Dynamic DNS Service Service Provider NETGEAR Do you have a NETGEAR DDNS or a No IP DDNS account Yes No Host Name mynetgear com Email Password 6 32 characters Forget your password click here To manage your DDNS account click here In the Host Name field enter the host name sometimes called the domain name for your account Depending on the type of account specify your user name or email address ForaNo IP or Dyn account
135. ction To set up an IPv6 Internet connection through autoconfiguration 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays Manage the Internet Settings Manually 91 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 From the Internet Connection Type menu select Auto Config I CAS Internet Connection Type Auto Config v DHCP User Class if Required DHCP Domain Name If Required Router s IPv6 Address On WAN Not Available LAN Setup Router s IPv6 Address On LAN Not Available IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config Use This Interface ID 0 0 0 0 IPv6 Filtering Secured Open The modem router automatically detects the information in the following fields e Router s IPv6 Address On WAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s WAN or Internet interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available e Router s IPv6 Address On LAN This field sh
136. d quietzo Quality of Service Off ReadySHARE f Guest Network gt ca Tt th Parental Controls ReadySHARE Guest Network STATUS NOT ENABLED STATUS READY STATUS NOT ENABLED Help amp Support Documentation Online Support Router FAQ GNU GPL Plia 5 a i Mag Enter Search Item ee The BASIC Home page displays a dashboard that lets you see the status of your Internet connection and network at a glance You can click any of the sections of the dashboard to view more detailed information The left column displays the menus and at the top is an ADVANCED tab that you can use to access more menus and pages Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 39 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Change the Language By default the language is set as Auto You can change the language To change the language 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Inthe upper right corner select a language from the menu When prompted click the OK button to confirm this change The page refreshes with the language that you selected Change the admin Password We recommend that you chan
137. d is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Make sure that the Port Forwarding radio button is selected Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 269 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 7 Click the Add Custom Service button EEZ EED Service Name Protocol TCP UDP v External Starting Port 1 65534 External Ending Port 1 65534 Vi Use the same port range for Internal port Internal Starting Port 1 65534 Internal Ending Port Internal IP address 192 168 1 Or select from currently attached devices IP Address Device Name 192 168 1 2 BUSINESSLAPTOP 8 Specify a new port forwarding rule with a custom service or application as described in the following table e E Enter the name of the custom service or application Protocol Select the protocol TCP or UDP that is associated with the service or application If you are unsure select TCP UDP External Starting Port Enter the starting port number for the service or application External Ending Port If the service or application uses a single port enter the same port number in the External Ending Port field If the service or application uses a range of ports enter the ending port number of the range in the External Ending Port field Internal Starting Port
138. d the HTTP service to the local address of your web server at 192 168 1 33 HTTP port 80 is the standard protocol for web servers 3 Optional Register a host name with a Dynamic DNS service and specify that name on the Dynamic DNS page of the modem router Dynamic DNS makes it much easier to access a server from the Internet because you can enter the name in the web browser Otherwise you must know the IP address that the ISP assigned which typically changes How the Modem Router Implements the Port Forwarding Rule The following sequence shows the effects of a port forwarding rule 1 When you enter the URL www example com in your browser the browser sends a web page request message with the following destination information e Destination address The IP address of www example com which is the address of your modem router Destination port number 80 which is the standard port number for a web server process The modem router receives the message and finds your port forwarding rule for incoming port 80 traffic The router changes the destination IP address in the message to 192 168 1 123 and sends the message to that computer 4 Your web server at IP address 192 168 1 123 receives the request and sends a reply message to your router Your modem router performs Network Address Translation NAT on the source IP address and sends the reply through the Internet to the computer or WiFi device that sent the web page reques
139. ddress do the following Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 37 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Select either the No or the I don t know radio button b Click the Next button Problem Detecting the Internet Connection MAC Address If you previously connected to your Internet service with a computer or another router NETGEAR Genie can use the same MAC address that worked before A MAC address is a unique number You can find the MAC address of the computer or router on its product label Enter the MAC address here format AABBCCODEEFF c Enter the MAC address of the computer or router with which you previously were able to connect to the Internet You might find the MAC address on the product label of your device Enter the MAC address in the AABBCCDDEEFF format not in the AA BB CC DD EE FF format d Click the Next button 18 If the Congratulations page still does not display and the modem router still does not connect to the Internet do the following a Review all your settings and make sure that you selected the correct options and entered everything correctly b Run the Setup Wizard one more time c Contact your ISP to verify that you are using the correct configuration information d Read Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 e If problems persist register your NETGEAR product and contact NETGEAR technical support When the modem router connec
140. del D7800 Position Your Modem Router The modem router lets you access your network anywhere within the operating range of your WiFi network However the operating distance or range of your WiFi connection can vary significantly depending on the physical placement of your modem router For example the thickness and number of walls the WiFi signal passes through can limit the range Additionally other WiFi access points in and around your home might affect your modem router s signal WiFi access points are routers repeaters WiFi range extenders and any other device that emits a WiFi signal for network access Position your modem router according to the following guidelines e Place your modem router near the center of the area where your computers and other devices operate and within line of sight to your WiFi devices Make sure that the modem router is within reach of an AC power outlet and near Ethernet cables for wired computers e Place the modem router in an elevated location minimizing the number walls and ceilings between the modem router and your other devices e Place the modem router away from electrical devices such as these Ceiling fans Home security systems Microwaves Computers Base of a cordless phone 2 4 GHz cordless phone e Place the modem router away from large metal surfaces large glass surfaces insulated walls and items such as these Solid metal door Aluminum studs Fish tanks Mirrors B
141. dem router do the following a Click the upper Edit button The Device Name page displays Type a new name in the Device Name field Click the Apply button A pop up window displays Click the Yes button e When the process is complete select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings The USB Storage Advanced Settings page displays again Share a Storage Device 155 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 By default the name is readyshare 6 To specify a name for the workgroup that the USB device or devices are members of in the Workgroup field enter a name By default the name is Workgroup The name works only in an operating system that supports NetBIOS such as Microsoft Windows If you are using a Windows workgroup rather than a domain the workgroup name is displayed here 7 Enable or disable access methods by selecting or clearing the corresponding check boxes and specifying access to the storage device as described in the following table Network Enabled by default You can type readyshare to access the storage device within your Neighborhood MacShare network If you change the name in the Network Device Name field from readyshare to another name the link changes accordingly Enabled by default You can type http readyshare routerlogin net shares to access the USB device within your network and download or upload files In this URL readyshare is the name that is specified in th
142. dem router cannot detect when the service or application terminates To specify the time out for port triggering 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 278 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select the Port Triggering radio button The port triggering settings display In the Port Triggering Time out field enter a value up to 9999 minutes The default setting is 20 minutes Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Disable Port Triggering By default port triggering is enabled You can disable port triggering temporarily without removing any port triggering rules To disable port triggering 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page dis
143. device uses special drivers it is not compatible Share a Storage Device 149 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Figure 11 Two 3 0 USB ports are located on the side of the modem router To connect a USB device 1 Insert your USB storage drive into a USB port on the side panel of the modem router 2 If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the modem router When you connect the USB device to the modem router USB port it might take up to two minutes before it is ready for sharing By default the USB device is available to all computers on your local area network LAN Access a Storage Device Connected to the Modem Router From a computer or device on the network you can access a storage device that is connected to the modem router Access the Storage Device From a Windows Computer To access the storage device from a Windows computer 1 Connect a USB storage device to a USB port or an eSATA storage device to the eSATA port on the modem router 2 If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the modem router When you connect the storage device to the modem router s port it might take up to two minutes before the storage device is ready for sharing By default the device is available to all computers on your local area network LAN On a Win
144. disable the idle time out enter 0 When you disable the idle time out the connection is not terminated automatically Your ISP uses DHOP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Router MAC Address Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If a secondary DNS server address is available enter it also The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use the default MAC address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The modem router cap
145. dows computer that is connected to the network select Start gt Run Enter readyshare in the dialog box Click the OK button A window displays the files and folders on the device Share a Storage Device 150 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Access the Storage Device From a Mac To access the storage device from a Mac 1 So Connect a USB storage device to a USB port or an eSATA storage device to the eSATA port on the modem router If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the modem router When you connect the storage device to the modem router s port it might take up to two minutes before the storage device is ready for sharing By default the device is available to all computers on your local area network LAN On a Mac that is connected to the network launch Finder and select Go gt Connect to Server The Connect to Server window displays In the Server Address field enter smb readyshare Click the Connect button When prompted select the Guest radio button If you set up access control on the router and you allowed your Mac to access the network select the Registered User radio button and enter admin for the name and password for the password For more information about access control see Allow or Block Access to Your Network on page 119 Click the Connect button A window displays the f
146. dress The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address Use These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If secondary and tertiary DNS server addresses are available enter them also Manage the Internet Settings Manually 71 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option Enter the vendor class identifier VCI string as indicated by yo
147. dress Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address Use These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If a secondary DNS server address is available enter it also Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port Click the Apply button You
148. dress that your ISP assigned you for IPoA service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assigns this address Use These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If secondary and tertiary DNS server addresses are available enter them also Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option Enter the vendor class identifier V
149. dresses is forwarded to the ISDN modem router at 192 168 1 100 e A metric value of 1 works fine because the ISDN modem router is on the LAN Set Up a Static Route You can add a static route to a destination IP address and specify the subnet mask gateway IP address and metric To set up a static route 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 212 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Static Routes The Static Routes page displays Click the Add button Route Name Private v Active Destination IP Address IP Subnet Mask Gateway IP Address Metric To make the route private select the Private check box A private static route is not reported in RIP To prevent the route from becoming active after you click the Apply button clear the Active check box In some situations you might want to set up a static route but keep it disabled until a later time By default the Active check box is selected and a route becomes active after you click the Apply button Enter the settings as described in the following table Fea fe
150. driver software and TCP IP software are both installed and configured on your computer Verify that the IP address for your modem router and your computer are correct and that the addresses are on the same subnet Test the Path From Your Computer to a Remote Device After you verify that the LAN path works correctly test the path from your computer to a remote device To test the path from your computer to a remote device 1 2 From the Windows toolbar click the Start button and select Run In the field provided enter ping n 10 P address where IP address is the IP address of a remote device such as your ISP s DNS server If the path is functioning correctly replies as described in Test the LAN Path to Your Modem Router on page 291 display If you do not receive replies do the following Troubleshooting 292 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Check to see that the IP address of your modem router is listed as the default router in your computer If the IP configuration of your computer is assigned by DHCP this information is not visible in your computer s Network Control Panel Verify that the IP address of the modem router is listed as the default router Check to see that the network address of your computer the portion of the IP address specified by the netmask is different from the network address of the remote device If your ISP assigned a host name to your computer enter that ho
151. dwidth Let Speedtest detect my Internet bandwidth recommended DOWNLOAD SPEED UPLOAD SPEED coweso o 4 Mbps Mbp OOKLA Speedtest want to define my Internet bandwidth Performance Optimization Database W Automatically update performance optimization database Current Performance timization Database on Router Release Date March 30 2015 Help improve the Quality of Service feature by sharing analytics with NETGEAR Click here to learn more about how we collect use and share analytics information If you are using Dynamic QoS the Dynamic QoS check box is selected Select or clear the Automatically update performance optimization database check box Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Optimize Performance 142 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manually Update the Dynamic QoS Database The modem router uses a QoS database of the most popular applications and services to implement Dynamic QoS By default the modem router automatically updates this database when you enable Dynamic QoS but if you turned off the automatic update feature you can manually update the database To manually update the Dynamic QoS database 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is
152. e Share Name T_Drive Read Access All no password Write Access All no password Apply gt x Close Window c Inthe Read Access menu select admin The default setting is All no password d Inthe Write Access menu select admin The default setting is All no password e Click the Apply button Your settings are saved f Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes Use FTP to Access Storage Devices Through the Internet If you attached a storage device to the modem router before you can access the storage device through the Internet with FTP you must first set it up see Set Up FTP Access Through the Internet on page 173 Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 174 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To access a USB device with FTP from a remote computer to download or upload a file 1 Take one of the following actions e To download a file from a storage device connected to the modem router launch a web browser e To upload a file to a storage device connected to the modem router launch an FTP client such as Filezilla Type ftp and the Internet port IP address in the address field of the browser For example if your IP address is 10 1 65 4 type ftp 10 1 65 4 If you are using Dynamic DNS type the DNS name For example type ftp MyName mynetgear com in which MyName is your DNS name When prompted log in
153. e Enable VLAN Bridge Group check box The page expands Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 198 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 6 Select the By bridge group radio button VLAN Bridge Settings cance A ay V Enable VLAN Bridge group By bridge group Wired Ports Wireless Poti Potz Clwitiz4c C WiFi5G ClPot3 C Port4 By VLAN tag group 7 Select a Wired Ports check box or a Wireless check box e If your device is connected to an Ethernet port on the modem router select the Wired Ports check box that corresponds to the Ethernet port on the modem router to which the device is connected e If your device is connected to your modem router s WiFi network select the Wireless check box that corresponds to the modem router s WiFi network to which the device is connected Note You must select at least one Wired Ports or Wireless check box You can select more than one check box 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up a Bridge for a VLAN Tag Group If the devices that are connected to the modem router s Ethernet LAN ports or WiFi network include an IPTV device your ISP might require you to set up a bridge for a VLAN tag group for the modem router s Internet interface If you are subscribed to IPTV service the modem router might require VLAN tags to distinguish between the Internet traffic and the IPTV traffic A bridge with a VLAN tag group prevents packets th
154. e For Windows button to download the OpenVPN configuration files Step 17 provides information about what to do with the downloaded OpenVPN configuration files To download the OpenVPN client utility visit openvpn net index php download community downloads html In the Windows Installer section of the page double click the openVPN install xxx exe link Download the file Use VPN to Access Your Network 259 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 10 To install the OpenVPN client utility on your computer click the openVPN install xxx exe file UF OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 Setup fo es Welcome to the OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 Setup Wizard This wizard will guide you through the installation of OpenVPN an Open Source VPN package by James Yonan Note that the Windows version of OpenVPN will only run on Windows XP or higher 11 Click the Next button 12 Read the License Agreement and click the I Agree button OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 Setup fol ea Choose Component PEN Crooze vi ete of OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 you want to instal Select the components to install upgrade Stop any OpenVPN processes or the OpenVPN service if itis running All DLLs are installed locally Select components to install 13 Leave the check boxes selected as shown in the previous figure and click the Next button 14 To specify the destination folder click the Browse button select a destinat
155. e Network Device Name field If you change the name in the Network Device Name field from readyshare to another name the link changes accordingly You can also click the link that is shown in the Link column The fixed port is number is 80 HTTPS via internet Disabled by default If you enable this feature remote users can type https lt public IP address gt shares to access the USB device over the Internet lt public IP address gt is the external or public IP address that is assigned to the modem router for example 1 1 10 102 This feature supports file uploading only The default port is number 443 which you can change Enabled by default You can type ftp readyshare routerlogin net shares to access the USB device within your network and download or upload files In this URL readyshare is the name that is specified in the Network Device Name field If you change the name in the Network Device Name field from readyshare to another name the link changes accordingly You can also click the link that is shown in the Link column The fixed port is number is 21 FTP via internet Disabled by default If you enable this feature remote users can type ftp lt public IP address gt shares to access the USB device over the Internet and download or upload files lt public IP address gt is the external or public IP address that is assigned to the modem router for example 1 1 10 102 The default port is number 21 which you can cha
156. e These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If a secondary DNS server address is available enter it also Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Manage the Internet Settings Manually 58 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e bea S Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port 12 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 13 Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection You can view or change the modem router s VDSL Internet c
157. e e l Wireless Network 2 4GHz b g n Enable SSID Broadcast By default the modem router broadcasts its SSID so that WiFi stations can detect the WiFi name SSID in their scanned network lists To turn off the SSID broadcast clear the Enable SSID Broadcast check box Turning off the SSID broadcast provides additional WiFi security but users must know the SSID to be able to join the WiFi network of the modem router Name SSID The SSID is the WiFi network name If you did not change the SSID the default SSID displays The default SSID is also printed on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 Note We recommend that you do not change the default SSID If you must change the SSID enter a 32 character maximum case sensitive name in this field Channel From the Channel menu select Auto for automatic channel selection or select an individual channel The default selection is Auto Note In some regions not all channels are available Do not change the channel unless you experience interference shown by lost connections or slow data transfers If this situation occurs experiment with different channels to see which is the best If you use multiple WiFi access points APs reduce interference by selecting different channels for adjacent APs We recommend a channel spacing of four channels between adjacent APs for example use Channels 1 and 5 or 6 and 10 Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 99 Nigh
158. e fastest speed If your network includes older devices that do not support WPA2 select WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES security To use WPA2 security in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES This type of security enables WiFi devices that support either WPA or WPA2 to join the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network However WPA PSK TKIP is less secure than WPA2 PSK AES and limits the speed of WiFi devices to 54 Mbps To use WPA WPA2 security in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA WPA2 Enterprise This type of security requires that your WiFi network can access a RADIUS server For information about configuring WPA WPA2 Enterprise see Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiFi Security on page 104 Passphrase The passphrase that provides users access to the guest WiFi network in the 5 GHZ band The passphrase is also referred to as the password or key Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Make sure that you can reconnect over WiFi to the guest network If you cannot connect over WiFi check the following e If your computer or WiFi device is already connected to another WiFi network in your area disconnect it from that WiFi network and connect it to the WiFi network that the
159. e format and partitions For more information see Set Up a Storage Device on a Mac on page 152 If you plan to back up a large amount of data see Prepare to Back Up a Large Amount of Data on page 153 On a Mac computer that is connected to the network launch Finder and select Go gt Connect to Server The Connect to Server window displays 4 Type smb routerlogin net and click the Connect button When prompted select the Registered User radio button Enter admin for the name and password for the password and click the Connect button A list of USB devices connected to your router displays 7 From the Apple menu select System Preferences The System Preferences window displays 8 Select Time Machine The Time Machine window displays 9 Click the Select Backup Disk button and select your USB device from the list 10 Click the Use Disk button Note If you do not see the USB partition that you want in the Time Machine disk list go to Mac Finder and click that USB partition It displays in the Time Machine list 11 When prompted select the Registered User radio button 12 Enter admin for the name and password for the password and click the Connect button The setup is complete and the Mac automatically schedules a full backup You can back up immediately if you want Manage Access to a Storage Device You can specify the device name workgroups and network folders for a storage device connected to the USB port on th
160. e modem router To specify the storage device access settings 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Share a Storage Device 154 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Apply gt Network Device Name o0 C Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port e Network Neighborhood MacShare 07800 V HTTP http readyshare routerlogin nevshares 80 F HTTP via internet 192 168 100 1 har 443 FIP fip readyshare routerlogin netishares 21 F FTP via internet 192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space WO7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgear com Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router 5 To specify a name that is used to access the USB device or devices that are connected to the mo
161. e modem router functions as a modem router and WiFi access point AP You can change the operation mode to a mode in which the modem router functions as a standalone AP on your existing network For AP mode you must connect the modem router to the router on your existing network In AP mode features such routing firewall and traffic meter are disabled on the modem router because these functions if supported are performed by the router Note To avoid interference with the router to which you connect the modem router we recommend that you use different WiFi settings on the modem router functioning in AP mode and the router You can also turn off the WiFi radio on the router and use the modem router only for WiFi client access To set up the modem router as an AP 1 Use an Ethernet cable to connect the red Internet port of the modem router to a LAN port on the router 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 252 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 3 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 4 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 5 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Router AP Mode The Router AP Mode page displays 6 Select the AP Mode radio b
162. e polling frequency or stop polling e To change the polling frequency do the following a Inthe Poll Interval field enter a time in seconds b Click the Set Interval button e To stop polling click the Stop button View Renew or Release the TCP IP Internet Connection You can view information about a TCP IP Internet connection of the modem router and renew or release such a connection This information displays only if the modem router connects to the ISP network over a TCP IP connection Such a connection usually functions over an Ethernet WAN connection To view the status of the TCP IP Internet connection or renew or release the TCP IP Internet connection 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays 5 Inthe Internet Port pane click the Connection Status button The Connection Status pop up window opens The fields that display depend on the type of Internet connection The following table describes the fields for a TCP IP connection with DHCP ee pa y IP Address The IP address that is assigned by the ISP to the modem router Subnet Mask The subnet mask that i
163. e security settings from the modem router so that every device in the network supports the same security settings To use WPS to connect a device to the WiFi network of the modem router 1 2 3 4 Make sure that the modem router is receiving power its Power LED is lit Check the WPS instructions for your computer or WiFi device Press the WPS button of the modem router for three seconds Within two minutes press the WPS button on your WiFi device or follow the WPS instructions that came with the device The WPS process automatically sets up the device with the network password and connects the device to the WiFi network of the modem router For more information see Use WPS to Add a Device to the WiFi Network on page 108 Types of Logins Separate types of logins serve different purposes This section describes the differences so that you know which login to use when Types of logins Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 22 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ISP login The login that your Internet service provider ISP gave you logs you in to your Internet service Your ISP gave you this login information in a letter or some other way If you cannot find this login information contact your ISP e WiFi network key or password Your modem router is preset with a unique WiFi network name SSID and password for WiFi access This information is on the product label Use th
164. e the ANU AGS icsscs nccnrsenwnacivesecdnsaicbsauransadeyadecumnacsiacseanatetiendentedeuaeeernncetl 40 Change the admin PaSSWOId c cceeeceeeeeeeeceeeeeesaeeeeeeeaaeeeeeaeeesteneeeeeeeneaaaeees 40 Set Up Password GCOVEIY sicscsecicsacctcstsiieeien interned eee eee 41 Let the Modem Router Automatically Update Its Firmware ccceeeeeeeeee 42 Access the Modem Router With the NETGEAR genie App seeeeeeeeee 42 Chapter 3 Manage the Internet Settings Manually Use the Internet Setup Wizard After Initial S tup eee eeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeneeeeeeee 45 Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection cccccecseeeeceeeeeeeesseneeeeeeeeees 50 Specify an ADSL Connection Without a LOQIN cccccceceeeeesseteeeeeeeeeeeeees 50 Specify an ADSL Connection With a Login and PPPoA or PPPoE Service 55 Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection cccceeeessseceeeeeeeeseseeneeeeeeeees 59 Specify a VDSL Connection Without a LOQIN cccccceeeeeseetenteeeeeeeeeeeeees 59 Specify a VDSL Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service 2 06 64 Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection cccccccessseeteeeeeeeees 68 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection Without a LOGIN c seeeeeeeeeeeeee 68 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service 72 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Specify a Cable or Fibe
165. ect the country in which you use the modem router Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 34 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 13 From the Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other 14 Select the Yes radio button 15 Click the Next button Detecting the Internet Connection This process can take a minute or two please wait r O PS When the modem router is connected to the Internet the Congratulations page displays and you successfully completed the setup process If the Congratulations page does not display other pages might display and you might need to provide more information in which case you must continue with the next step The pages that display depend on your type of ISP connection and configuration Congratulations You are successfully connected to the Internet This router is preset with the following unique wireless network name SSID and network key password 2 4GHz Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 5GHz Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 5G Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 Take me to the Internet 16 Only if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the Internet connection Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 35 Nighth
166. ection The DSL port is shut down Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV Devices Some devices such as an IPTV cannot function behind the modem router s network address translation NAT service or firewall Based on what your Internet service provider ISP requires for the device to connect to the ISP s network directly you can enable the bridge between the device and the modem router s virtual IPTV interface In bridge mode by default the LAN 4 port on the back panel of the modem router is bound to the virtual IPTV interface In addition to connecting an IPTV device to the LAN 4 port you can connect an IPTV device to the LAN 3 port and another one to the LAN 2 port That is the modem router can support up to three IPTV devices The LAN 1 port is reserved for a wired Internet connection Do not connect an IPTV device to the LAN 1 port For information about enabling and configuring the virtual IPTV interface see one of the following sections Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 192 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 To enable bridge mode for one or more IPTV devices 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http
167. ectrical outlet Wait for the Power LED to light solid white which takes about two minutes 7 Ifthe Power LED does not light press the Power On Off button Wait for the WiFi LED to light solid white 8 If the WiFi LED does not light press the WiFi On Off button 9 Connect a computer to the modem router by one of the following methods Ethernet cable Use an Ethernet cable to connect your computer to a yellow Ethernet LAN port on the modem router The product package contains a yellow Ethernet cable Your computer connects to the modem router s LAN e WiFi Connect to the default WiFi network of the modem router a On your computer or WiFi device find and select the WiFi network The WiFi network name SSID is on the product label b Join the WiFi network and enter the WiFi password The password network key is on the product label Your computer or WiFi device connects to the modem router s WiFi network Noie If the computer is set to a static fixed IP address this setting is uncommon either change the computer to obtain an IP address automatically from the modem router through DHCP or change the IP address of the computer to a static IP address in the 192 168 1 2 192 168 1 254 range 10 Launch a web browser Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 33 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The modem router checks the Internet connection sie NETGEAR genie
168. ed the setup process If the Congratulations page does not display other pages might display and you might need to provide more information in which case you must continue with the next step The pages that display depend on your type of ISP connection and configuration Congratulations You are successfully connected to the Internet This router is preset with the following unique wireless network name SSID and network key password 2 4GHz Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 5GHz Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR23 5G Wireless Network Key Password jaggedtrumpet276 17 Only if you are using a DSL connection and the following page displays Specify a full scan to let the Setup Wizard find the PVC protocol The page that might display asks you if you need the Setup Wizard to do a full scan to find the PVC protocol If this page does not display continue with Step 18 Do you need Setup Wizard to do full scan to find the PVC Protocol Yos This will take approximotely 1 to 6 minutes No want to configure the router myself Do the following Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 28 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Select the Yes radio button b Click the Next button The Setup Wizard performs a full scan which might take up to six minutes This takes approximately 1 to 6 minutes i4 T a 18 Only
169. eeseceeeeeeneeeeeeesaaeeeeeeeaeeeeeeseeeees 124 Set Up 1B 5 ere 4 9 9 Pepe eereen tpn ie ie mere een ere eee eee ere perro perce 125 Remove a Keyword or Domain From the Blocked List sceeeeeeeeeees 126 Remove All Keywords and Domains From the Blocked List 008 127 Specify a Trusted COMPUuter cccceeecceeeeeeneceeeeeseaeeeeeesaeeseeeeeeeeeeeeaaaeeees 127 Manage Simple Outbound Firewall Rules for Services and Applications 128 Add an Outbound Firewall RUNG wasciscsaemestasiecaiinessnaneniiamiaimndined 129 Add an Outbound Firewall Rule for a Custom Service or Application 130 Change an Outbound Firewall RUule ececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeee 133 Remove an Outbound Firewall RUI ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeesenaeeeeneeas 134 Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules 134 Set Up Security Event Email Notifications ccc eeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeneaes 136 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Chapter 6 Optimize Performance Use Dynamic QoS to Optimize Internet Traffic Management eeeeeee 140 Enable DY Man GAGS vaccbico sbcascaaiendadsresecterssieenanisveliaeeatinnaeernaninenuactee 140 Enable or Disable the Automatic QoS Database Update cceeee 141 Manually Update the Dynamic QoS Database eceeeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeees 143 Participate in Dynamic QoS
170. eeseeeeeeenentees 154 Enable FTP Access Within Your Network cccccceeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeees 157 View Network Folders on a DeVICC c ccccceescceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeaaeeeeetsaaeeeeeneaas 158 Add a Network Folder on a Storage DeVICE ccccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeenneeeeeneees 159 Change a Network Folder Including Read and Write Access on a USB Drive 162 Approve SICA SD VIC asi ate cathe av vecznctesceastise dastacstideh vadentsane Madden iacareensetere 163 Safely Remove a USB Devit iis sccicsscccisiesesniisinniemieanies tvereanio ieeiines 165 Chapter 8 Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS ccccccceecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaeeeeeenaaeeeeeneaas 168 Your Personal FTP Servet isicsectsnpadcsscatsaecstinetea nap dmerninbianenianaieninmniciniad 168 Set Up a New Dynamic DNS ACCOUNL ececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeaeeeee 169 Specify a DNS Account That You Already Created cc ccceeceeeeeeeeseees 170 Change the Dynamic DNS SettingS eecccceeeessceeeeeeeseeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeaeeeeees 172 Access Storage Devices Through the Internet c cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeetteeeeeeeees 172 Access Storage Devices From a Remote Computet ceeseeceeeeeeeeeees 172 Set Up FTP Access Through the Internet cecseeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 173 Use FTP to Access Storage Devices Through the Internet
171. el to Access Your Internet Service at Home t To access your Internet service 1 Set up the modem router to allow VPN access to your Internet service See Set Up VPN Client Internet Access in the Modem Router on page 264 On your computer launch the OpenVPN application The OpenVPN icon displays in the Windows taskbar Right click the icon and select Connect When the VPN connection is established launch your web browser Use VPN to Access Your Network 266 Manage Port Forwarding and Port 1 5 Triggering You can use port forwarding and port triggering to set up rules for Internet traffic for services and applications You need networking knowledge to set up these features This chapter includes the following sections e Manage Port Forwarding to a Local Server for Services and Applications on page 268 Manage Port Triggering for Services and Applications on page 273 267 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manage Port Forwarding to a Local Server for Services and Applications If a server is part of your network you can allow certain types of incoming traffic to reach the server For example you might want to make a local web server FTP server or game server visible and available to the Internet The modem router can forward incoming traffic with specific protocols to computers on your local network You can specify the servers for applications and you can also specify a default DMZ ser
172. em Router for DSL Service and Access the Modem Router on page 24 If you use a cable or fiber modem follow the procedure that is described in Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber Service on page 32 DSL Service Make sure that your ADSL or VDSL service is active before you install the modem router You need the following information to install your DSL modem and connect to the Internet e DSL user name and password This information is included in the welcome letter your DSL ISP sent you when you signed up for your service Record your DSL Internet service account user name and password Your telephone number or DSL account number If you do not use voice service you can use your DSL account number in place of a phone number If you do not know or cannot locate your DSL user name and password call your DSL Internet service provider ISP Be specific when speaking with your DSL Internet service provider For example you could say I need my DSL service user name and password Can you help me Noie If your provider says that they do not support NETGEAR services tell them that you need only your DSL user name and password You do not need support Cable the Modem Router for DSL Service and Access the Modem Router The following figure shows the cabling of your modem router for DSL service Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 24 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Fi
173. en sn 272 Application Example Make a Local Web Server Public ccceeeeeee 272 How the Modem Router Implements the Port Forwarding Rule 273 Manage Port Triggering for Services and Applications cccceeeeeeeeeees 273 Add a Port Triggering Ul Gist sdrtcessttnanisteictarian eter 274 Change a Port Triggering RUIC c ccccccceccssssseeeeeeeeeeesesseseeeeeeeeeeeessesenaaas 276 Remove a Port Triggering RUule ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeees 277 Specify the Time Out for Port Triggering scccccccesseseseseceeeeeeeeessesaees 278 Disable Port Triggering ensen ratni a a a E Maken 279 Application Example Port Triggering for Internet Relay Chat e 280 Chapter 16 Troubleshooting Reboot the Modem Router From Its Web Page cc ceesseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeees 282 Quick Tips for TOUDISSNOOU NG ssccrescvcuse tected etanserandnamvcapaicanditaceicneaniuurnantees 282 Troubleshoot With the LEDS ssessececeeeeeeeaeeeaaeeaaeeaaeeaaeeaeeeaeeeaeeeaeeeaeeeas 284 Power LED 1S Ciisinteadlaseassentsaecrruacasun aietatinntantiiaonanenetintarius a R 285 Power LED Remains Solid AMD6 ccsssceceeeeeeeseesneeeeeeeessessnsneeeeeeess 285 MT TE IS Off corte tats i edondsestess deel onaatersad tcaestectatueie ceaeerteneineiteee 286 You Cannot Log In to the Modem Router c cccceeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeseenaeeeeeeeas 28
174. ency range US 2 412 2 462 GHz Europe 2 412 2 472 GHz Australia 2 412 2 472 GHz Japan 2 412 2 472 GHz 5 GHz band US 5 18 5 24 5 745 5 825 GHz and DFS 5 25 5 35 5 50 5 70 Europe 5 18 5 24 GHz and DFS 5 25 5 35 5 50 5 70 Australia 5 18 5 24 5 745 5 825 GHz and DFS 5 25 5 35 5 50 5 70 Japan 5 18 5 24 GHz and DFS 5 25 5 35 5 50 5 70 802 11 security WPA2 PSK WPA PSK WPA WPA2 mixed mode WPA WPA2 Enterprise and WEP xDSL data rate VDSL2 VDSL ADSL2 ADSL2 and ADSL multimode Up to 100 Mbps both upstream and downstream Supports Annex A L and M Supports all VDSL2 profiles 8a 8b 8c 8d 12a 12b and 17a VDSL2 interface compliance with ITU T993 2 G 992 1 G dmt Annex A compliant G 992 2 G lite Annex A compliant ANSI T1 413 compliant G 992 3 ADSL2 compliant Annex A L and M G 992 5 ADSL2 compliant supporting Annex A and M G 993 2 compliant Annex A G 993 5 Vectoring ATM and PTM dual priority Note For more information see the data sheet for the D7800 modem router which is available at downloadcenter netgear com Supplemental Information 299
175. er button NETGEAR USB Control Center The scanner page displays so that you can use the USB printer for scanning Share a USB Printer 188 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manage the NETGEAR USB Control Center Settings You can stop the NETGEAR USB Control Center from starting automatically when you log in to Windows You can also change the language and specify the time out to release the printer connection Turn Off Automatic Startup of the NETGEAR USB Control Center You can stop the NETGEAR USB Control Center from starting automatically when you log in to Windows To turn off the automatic startup of the NETGEAR USB Control Center 1 Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon Ei IH NETGEAR USB Control Center System Tools About Device Audi 4 Control Center Configuration Basic Automatically execute when logging on Windows Timeout 10 minute 1 600 Language German Swedish French Dutch Italian Note Language setting will take effect on next execution 3 Clear the Automatically execute when logging on Windows check box 4 Click the OK button Your settings are saved Share a USB Printer 189 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Change the NETGEAR USB Control Center Language To change the language 1 Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon E The main page displays 2 Select Tools gt Configura
176. er usually detects and discards incoming traffic from the Internet that is not a response to one of your local computers or a service or application for which you set up a port forwarding or port triggering rule Instead of discarding this traffic you can direct the modem router to forward the traffic to one computer on your network This computer is called the default DMZ server To set up a default DMZ server 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays Select the Default DMZ Server check box Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 202 6 7 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enter the IP address of the server Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage IGMP Proxying IGMP proxying allows a computer on the local area network LAN to receive the multicast traffic it is interested in from the Internet If you do not need this feature leave it disabled which is the default setting To enable IGMP proxying 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http
177. eseneeeeeeeeeeees 217 Check for New Firmware and Update the Modem Routet eeee 217 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Manually Upload New Firmware and Update the Modem Router 218 Manage the Configuration File of the Modem Routet ccccccsssseeseeeeees 219 Back Up he Sting Siccsicctasnscantaseastecntexdaeneatigeedinenseseeecsaratvannend ERARE E 219 Restore the SONS a 22th Oc create ae act aetna ation 220 Recover the admin PaSSWOMd ccccccccsssssseeceeeeeeeeesseeeneceeeeeeesseseenaeeeeeeeeeeess 221 Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default SettingS cere 221 Use the Reset BulOM sissastiessircstbcaian chavenaiainiiad A RE 222 Erase th Set ngS receno aE aa a ae Er eee er 222 Disable LED Blinking or Turn Off LEDS sssssssessseneeeerressrrrrssrrnnnerennrrsrnresene 223 View the Status and Statistics of the Modem Routet cccccccesssessseeeeees 224 View Information About the Modem Router and the Internet and WiFi SeN Sane e E E E RE E eee apenas 224 View the Traftic StatiStiCS sisses aaa 229 Change the Traffic Statistics Polling Frequency c ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 230 View Renew or Release the TCP IP Internet Connection cc eee 231 View Establish or Terminate the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet Connection 232 View Establish or Terminate the PPTP or L2TP Internet Connection 233 View Dev
178. ess pool is 192 168 1 2 192 168 1 254 The modem router delivers the following parameters to any LAN device that requests DHCP e An IP address from the range that you define Subnet mask e Gateway IP address the modem router s LAN IP address e DNS server IP address the modem router s LAN IP address To specify the pool of IP addresses that the modem router assigns 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 207 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup LAN Setup Cx GHEE Denice iame oroo CECT LAN TCP IP Setup IP Address 192 166 1 IP Subnet Mask 255 1 255 1 255 0 RIP Direction Both hg RIP Version Disabled v V Use Router as DHCP Server Starting IP Address 192 1 168 1 12 Ending IP Address 192 1 168 1 254 Address Reservation IP Address Device Name MAC Address 5 Make sure that the Use Router as DHCP Server check box is selected This check box is selected by default 6 Specify the range of IP addresses that the modem router assigns e Inthe Single Start IP Address field enter the lo
179. et bandwidth recommended do the following a For more accurate Speedtest results make sure that no other devices are accessing the Internet b Click the Speedtest button Speedtest determines your Internet bandwidth 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved A link to the Attached Devices page displays at the bottom of the page Click the link to view bandwidth utilization For more information see View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 Enable or Disable the Automatic QoS Database Update The modem router uses a QoS database of the most popular applications and services to implement Dynamic QoS By default the modem router automatically updates this database You can turn off this feature and manually update the database Optimize Performance 141 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To enable or disable the automatic Dynamic QoS database update 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Quality of Service lt I am Dynamic QoS Automatic traffic prioritization by application and device QoS does not increase your total Internet bandwidth or WiFi throughput Internet Ban
180. etup The WAN Setup page displays Select a NAT Filtering radio button e Secured Provides a secured firewall to protect the computers on the LAN from attacks from the Internet but might prevent some Internet games point to point applications or multimedia applications from functioning By default the Secured radio button is selected e Open Provides a much less secured firewall but allows almost all Internet applications to function Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the SIP Application Level Gateway The application level gateway ALG for the Session Initiation Protocol SIP is enabled by default for enhanced address and port translation However some types of VoIP and video traffic might not work well when the SIP ALG is enabled For this reason the modem router provides the option to disable the SIP ALG t To change the default SIP ALG setting 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays To disable the SIP ALG select the Disable SIP ALG check box The SIP ALG is enabled by default Click the Apply button Your settings are saved
181. etup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays From the Internet Connection Type menu select Fixed Internet Connection Type Fixed WAN Setup IPv6 Address Prefix Length Default IPv6 Gateway Primary ONS Server Secondary DNS Server LAN Setup IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config IPv6 Address Prefix Length IPv6 Filtering Secured Open 6 Configure the fixed IPv6 addresses for the WAN connection IPv6 Address Prefix Length The IPv6 address and prefix length of the modem router WAN interface that your ISP provided to you Default IPv6 Gateway The IPv6 address of the default IPv6 gateway for the modem router s WAN interface that your ISP provided to you Primary DNS Server The primary DNS server that resolves IPv6 domain name records for the modem router that your ISP provided to you Secondary DNS Server The secondary DNS server that resolves IPv6 domain name records for the modem router that your ISP provided to you Manage the Internet Settings Manually 86 10 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Noie If you do not specify the DNS servers the modem router uses the DNS servers that are configured for the IPv4 Internet connection on the Internet Setup page see Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 or Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Select an IP Address Assignme
182. face ID check box and enter the interface ID Manage the Internet Settings Manually 92 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you do not specify an ID here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address 10 Select the IPv6 filtering mode Secured In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets e Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only 11 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the MTU Size The maximum transmission unit MTU is the largest data packet a network device transmits MTU Concepts When one network device communicates across the Internet with another the data packets travel through many devices along the way If a device in the data path uses a lower maximum transmission unit MTU setting than the other devices the data packets must be split or fragmented to accommodate the device with the smallest MTU The best MTU setting for NETGEAR equipment is often the default value In some situations changing the value fixes one problem but causes another Leave the MTU unchanged unless one of these situations occurs e You experience problems connecting to your ISP or other Internet service and the technical support of either the ISP or NETGEAR recommends changing the MTU setting These web based applications might require an MTU change e A secure website that does not o
183. fy the reserved IP address information e Inthe IP Address field enter the IP address to assign to the computer or device Choose an IP address from the modem router s LAN subnet such as 192 168 1 x e Inthe MAC Address field enter the MAC address of the computer or device Inthe Device Name field enter the name of the computer or device Click the Add button The reserved address is entered into the table on the LAN Setup page The reserved address is not assigned until the next time the computer or device contacts the modem router s DHCP server Reboot the computer or device or access its IP configuration and force a DHCP release and renew Change a Reserved IP Address You can change a reserved IP address entry To change a reserved IP address entry Le 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 209 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays In the Address Reservation section select the radio button next to the reserved address Click the Edit button The Edit page displays Change the settin
184. g white or solid white unless you turned off the WiFi radios Troubleshooting 284 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The WiFi LED is solid white unless you turned off the WiFi radios The WPS LED is solid white Note If USB devices and an eSATA device are attached to the modem router their associated LEDs also light You can use the LEDs for troubleshooting For more information see the following sections e Power LED Is Offon page 285 e Power LED Remains Solid Amber on page 285 e WiFi LED Is Off on page 286 e Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Power LED Is Off If the Power LED and other LEDs are off when your modem router is turned on do the following e Make sure that the Power On Off button on the back is in the on position that is it is pushed in e Make sure that the power cord is correctly connected to your modem router and that the power supply adapter is correctly connected to a functioning power outlet e Make sure that you are using the 12 VDC 3 5A power adapter that NETGEAR supplied for this product If the error persists a hardware problem might exist For recovery instructions or help with a hardware problem contact technical support at netgear com support Power LED Remains Solid Amber One second after the power is first applied the Power LED lights solid amber for about 10 seconds turns off for about 2 seconds and then lights solid ambe
185. ge displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Backup Settings The Backup Settings page displays Click the Erase button The configuration is reset to factory default settings When the reset is complete the modem router reboots This process takes about two minutes WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the reset For example do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white Disable LED Blinking or Turn Off LEDs The LEDs on the top panel of the modem router indicate activities and behavior You can disable LED blinking for network communications or turn off all LEDs except the Power LED To disable LED blinking or turn off the LEDs 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 223 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt LED Control Settings LECU UOT U Se I Enable blinking on Internet LED LAN LED Wireless LED USB LED and eSATA LED when data traffi
186. ge the default password that you use to log in to the modem router to a more secure password This is the password that you use to log in to the modem router with the user name admin The ideal password contains no dictionary words from any language and contains uppercase and lowercase letters numbers and symbols It can be up to 30 characters Noite This admin password is not the password that you use for WiFi access The label on your modem router shows your unique WiFi network name SSID and password for WiFi access To change the password for the user name admin 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 40 4 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Set Password Old Password ecccccce Set Password Repeat New Password Enable Password Recovery Enter the old password Enter the new password twice Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up Password Recovery We recommend that you enable password recovery if you change the password for the modem router user name admin Then you can recover the p
187. gns this address Use These DNS Servers If you know that your ISP does not automatically transmit DNS addresses to the modem router during login select this option and enter the IP address of your ISP primary DNS server If a secondary DNS server address is available enter it also Router MAC Address The Ethernet MAC address that the modem router uses on the Internet port Some ISPs register the MAC address of the network interface card in your computer when your account is first opened They accept traffic only from the MAC address of that computer This feature allows your modem router to use your computer s MAC address also called cloning Use Default Address Use the default MAC address Use Computer MAC Address The modem router captures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Use This MAC Address Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port 13 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 14 Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Specify an IPv6 Internet Connection If you want to use an IPv6 Internet connection you must specify the settings manually NETGEAR genie and the Setup Wizard do not detect an IPv6 Internet connectio
188. gs Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Remove a Reserved IP Address Entry You can remove a reserved IP address entry To remove a reserved IP address entry 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays In the Address Reservation section select the radio button next to the reserved address Click the Delete button The address entry is removed Disable the Built In DHCP Server By default the modem router functions as a DHCP server The modem router assigns IP DNS server and default gateway addresses to all devices connected to the LAN The assigned default gateway address is the LAN address of the modem router You can use another device on your network as the DHCP server or specify the network settings of all your computers Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 210 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Note If you disable the DHCP server and no other DHCP server is available on your network you must set your computer IP addresses manually so that they can access the modem router To disable the built in DHCP se
189. gs are saved Specify a Trusted Computer You can exempt one trusted device from blocking and logging The device that you exempt must be assigned a fixed static IP address To specify a trusted device 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Control Access to the Internet 127 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Sites Block Sites CCZ GLEE To learn more about advanced content filtering and keyword blocking features from NETGEAR please go to www netgearcomiipc Keyword Blocking Never D Per Schedule Always Type keyword or domain name here Add Keyword Block sites containing these keywords or domain names Delete Keyword Clear List F Allow trusted IP address to visit blocked sites Trusted IP Address 192 168 1 Scroll down and select the Allow trusted IP address to visit blocked sites check box In the Trusted IP Address field enter the IP address of the trusted device The first three octets of the IP address are automatically populated and depend on the IP address that is assigned to the modem router on the LAN Setup page 7 Click the Ap
190. gs for the IPv6 connection Noie Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you To set up an IPv6 Internet connection by using a 6to4 tunnel 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays Manage the Internet Settings Manually 83 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 From the Internet Connection Type menu select 6to4 Tunnel 3 Internet Connection Type 6to4 Tunnel X Remote 6to4 Relay Router Auto Static IP Address 0 0 10 10 LAN Setup Router s IPv6 Address On LAN Not Available IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config Use This Interface ID 0 10 0 710 IPv6 Filtering Secured Open The modem router automatically detects the information in the Router s IPv6 Address On LAN field This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s LAN interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address 6 Select a Remote 6to4 Relay Router radio button e Auto Your modem router uses any remote relay modem route
191. gure 7 Modem router cabling for DSL service t To connect your modem router to a DSL service 1 Unplug your DSL modem s power leaving the DSL modem connected to the wall jack for your Internet service 2 If your DSL modem includes a battery backup remove the battery 3 Install an ADSL or DSL microfilter between the phone line and the phone The product package contains either an ADSL or DSL microfilter 4 Use a phone cable to connect the microfilter to the gray DSL port on the modem router The product package contains a phone cable If your DSL modem includes a battery backup reinsert the battery Plug in your DSL modem s power and turn on your DSL modem Connect the power adapter to the modem router and plug it into an electrical outlet Wait for the Power LED to light solid white which takes about two minutes Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 25 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 8 If the Power LED does not light press the Power On Off button Wait for the WiFi LED to light solid white 9 If the WiFi LED does not light press the WiFi On Off button 10 Connect a computer to the modem router by one of the following methods Ethernet cable Use an Ethernet cable to connect your computer to a yellow Ethernet LAN port on the modem router The product package contains a yellow Ethernet cable Your computer connects to the modem router s LAN WiFi Connect
192. h as Comodo blocks NETGEAR USB Control Center from accessing the USB printer If you do not see the USB printer displayed onscreen you can disable the firewall temporarily to allow the utility to work 5 Select the printer and click the Connect button The printer status changes to Manually connected by Mycomputer Now only the computer that you are using can use this printer 6 Click the Disconnect button The status changes to Available Now all computers on the network can use the printer 7 To exit the utility select System gt Exit Share a USB Printer 185 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Use the Shared Printer For each computer after you click the Connect and Disconnect buttons once the utility automatically manages the printing queue By default the utility starts automatically whenever you log on to Windows and runs in the background Manually Connect and Print For each computer after you click the Connect and Disconnect buttons once the utility automatically manages the printing queue By default the utility starts automatically whenever you log on to Windows and runs in the background To manually connect and print l Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon The main page displays Click the Connect button The printer status changes to Manually connected by Mycomputer Now only the computer that you are using can use this printer Use the print feature in yo
193. hapter contains the following sections Install the Printer Driver and Cable the Printer on page 183 Download the ReadySHARE Printer Utility on page 183 Install the ReadySHARE Printer Utility on page 183 e Use the Shared Printer on page 186 e View or Change the Status of a Printer on page 187 e Use the Scan Feature of a Multifunction USB Printer on page 187 e Manage the NETGEAR USB Control Center Settings on page 189 182 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Install the Printer Driver and Cable the Printer Some USB printer manufacturers for example HP and Lexmark request that you do not connect the USB cable until the installation software prompts you to do so To install the driver and cable the printer 1 On each computer on your network that shares the USB printer install the driver software for the USB printer If the printer driver is not installed contact the printer manufacturer 2 Use a USB printer cable to connect the USB printer to a modem router USB port on the left side panel Download the ReadySHARE Printer Utility The utility works on Windows computers Mac computers smartphones and tablets To download the ReadySHARE Printer utility 1 Visit netgear com readyshare 2 Scroll down to the Print From the Comfort of Your Home Network section at the bottom of the page 3 Click one of the following links e Download PC installer and get started This is the utili
194. he Blocked List If you set up an access list that allows all new devices to access your network but you want to block some devices from accessing your network you must specify the devices that you want to block To add or remove devices that are blocked 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Control Access to the Internet 121 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Access Control The Access Control page displays Click the View list of blocked devices not currently connected to the network link Access Control CCZ ENED You can use Access Control to allow or block computers or electronic devices from accessing your network Yi Turn on Access Control Access Rule This is a general rule You can also allow or block individual devices Allow all new devices to connect Block all new devices from connecting Status Device Name IP Address MAC Address Connection Type Allowed BUSINESSLAPTOP 192 168 1 2 60 66 66 DA 66 7C Wireless NETGEAR84 gt View list of allowed devices not currently connected to the network w View list of blocked devices not currently connected to the netw
195. he Traffic Control section enter a value in minutes to specify when the modem router issues a warning message before the monthly limit in hours is reached This setting is optional The modem router issues a warning when the balance falls under the number of minutes that you enter By default the value is 0 and no warning message is issued Select one or more of the following actions to occur when the limit is reached Turn the Internet LED to flashing white amber This setting is optional When the traffic limit is reached the Internet LED blinks alternating white and amber Disconnect and disable the Internet connection This setting is optional When the traffic limit is reached the Internet connection is disconnected and disabled Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts The Internet Traffic Statistics section helps you to monitor the data traffic For more information see View the Internet Traffic Volume and Statistics on page 238 Restrict Internet Traffic by Connection Time You can record and restrict the traffic by connection time This is useful when your ISP measures your connection time To record and restrict the Internet traffic by time 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default pass
196. he modem router from its web page ie 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Click the ADVANCED tab The ADVANCED Home page displays In the Router Information pane click the Reboot button A confirmation pop up window displays Click the OK button The modem router reboots Quick Tips for Troubleshooting The following table includes tips for troubleshooting some common problems Troubleshooting 282 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Table 4 Quick tips for troubleshooting Your network is unresponsive or does ___ Restart your network not function normally 1 2 3 You cannot connect over an Ethernet cable to the modem router You cannot connect over WiFi to the modem router Turn off and unplug the DSL cable or fiber modem Turn off the modem router Plug in the DSL cable or fiber modem and turn it on Wait two minutes Turn on the modem router and wait two minutes If network problems still occur make sure that your ISP does not require you to use the MAC address of the computer that was used to initially register the ISP account If your ISP does require that you do this you must
197. hen you configure a VDSL connection without a login Internet Setup IED COZ GEL Select Country USA Fe Select Internet Service Provider Other X Transfer Mode VDSL PTM DSL Mode VDSL2 Internet Y Enable This interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED vel 8 vel Seu Use VLANID Priority 0 7 o Does your Internet connection require a login Yes No Account Name If Required D7800 Domain Name If Required Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address IP Address 0 0 L10 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 0 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Use IP Over ATM IPoA IP Address 0 0 0 0 IP Subnet Mask 0 0 0 0 Gateway IP Address 0 0 0 0 Domain Name Server DNS Address Get Automatically from ISP Use These DNS Servers Primary DNS Secondary DNS Third ONS Router MAC Address Use Default Address Use Computer MAC Address Use This MAC Address a0 63 91 7a 14 99 DHCP Options Vendor Class Identifier String option 60 Client Identifier String option 61 10 Enter the VDSL settings as described in the following table Manage the Internet Settings Manually 61 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Description Multiplexing Method These settings are disabled because they do not apply to a VDSL connection Use VLANID Select the Use VLANID check box and enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP AVLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to
198. i SeCULity ceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 104 Configure WEP Legacy WiFi SeCULity ceeeeeceeeeneeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeeeteeneeees 106 Use WPS to Add a Device to the WiFi Network ccscceeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeees 108 Use WPS With the Push Button Method ccecceeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeneeeeeneees 108 Use WPS With the PIN MeO cojcncsoscresccintersdeesibenicsuettenuede ance esnceeoeas 109 Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Guest Network 110 Control the WiFi RaAdiOS c cccccccccccsssssseeeeeeeeeesseeesneeeeeeeesseseseeeeeeeeeeeeseseaaas 115 Use the WiFi On Off BURON sa iaicaissssasssicntsnnda Gesantieatiiatidide teria tsadeaieeeenninils 115 Enable or Disable the WiFi RAdioS cccssccccceeeeeesesseeeeeeeeessessnseneeeeeees 115 Chapter 5 Control Access to the Internet Set Up Parental Control ges iaccaicisccpecenssncartasseiieasnecsaceiensabea chasaareusdsedeeaneenseeeearieees 118 Allow or Block Access to Your Network cccccccesssseeeneeeeeeeeeeessennneeeeeeeeeeess 119 Enable and Manage Network Access Control c cccccecceeeeeeteeeeeeeeeneeeeeeees 119 Manage Network Access Control LiSts cc cceeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeneeeees 121 Add Devices to or Remove Them From the Blocked List ceee 121 Add Devices to or Remove Them From the Allowed List cee 123 Use Keywords to Block Internet Sites cccce
199. iately click the Send Log button To clear the log entries click the Clear Log button The modem router emails the logs to the address that you specified see Set Up Security Event Email Notifications on page 136 Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 236 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Specify Which Activities Are Logged You can specify which activities are logged These activities display in the log and are forwarded to the syslog server if you enabled the syslog server function To manage which activities are logged 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Logs The Logs page displays Select the check boxes that correspond to the activities that you want to be logged By default all check boxes are selected Clear the check boxes that correspond to the activities that you do not want to be logged Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Monitor and Meter Internet Traffic Traffic metering allows you to monitor the volume of Internet traffic that passes through the modem router Internet port With the traffic meter utility you ca
200. ice Share a Storage Device 162 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 6 Click the Edit button ork Folder USB Device U STORE N GO messem f O All no password v Change the settings in the fields as needed For more information about the settings see Add a Network Folder on a Storage Device on page 159 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes Approve Storage Devices For more security you can set up the modem router to share only storage devices that you approve To allow only approved storage devices to connect to the modem router and specify which storage devices are approved 1 2 3 Make sure that the storage device or devices that you want to approve are attached to the modem router Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Share a Storage Device 163 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt USB Settings Enable any USB Device connected to the USB port Yes No 6 Select the No radio button By default the Yes radio button is selected This set
201. ices Currently on the Network ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenaeeeeeeenaaeeeeeeeas 234 Manage the Activity LOs isc srenronr enna Eaa a NENE 235 VIEW MEL OgS kie a a e E a cee 235 Specify Which Activities Are LOQQed ccccceeeesseeeeeteseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 237 Monitor and Meter Internet Traffic ccccccccsssssccceeeeeeeeesseenneeeeeeeseeseeeeeeeeeess 237 Start the Traffic Meter Without Traffic Volume Restrictions cccce 237 View the Internet Traffic Volume and StatistiCs 0 ccccceesecceeeeeeeeeeeenees 238 Restrict Internet Traffic by VOIUME cccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeesaaeeeeneaas 239 Restrict Internet Traffic by Connection Time cceceeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeteeeetees 241 Unblock the Traffic Meter After the Traffic Limit Is Reached cc008 243 Manage the Modem Router Remotely cccccceereeeeeecceeeeeeeseesseeeeneneeeees 243 Chapter 13 Manage the Advanced WiFi Features Set Up a WiFi Sched l ranice nda UI arson E eee 247 Manage the WPS SettingS nneeseneeeeneensseerrrerenntrernrressrrrnnerrnnnnrrnnntssrnrnserrnn nne 249 Manage Advanced WiFi SettingS cceececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeseaeeeeeeneeeeeneeneeees 250 Set Up the Modem Router as a WiFi Access Point Onlly ccceeeeeeteeeeeeees 252 Set Up ge elle ao c aereeeemnene enero reer eer ees nee eee eee ee a 253 Chapter 14 Use VPN to Access Your Network Set
202. if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the Internet connection The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection If this page does not display continue with Step 19 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection This is most likely due to one of the following reasons corrected a problem with the DSL Ethemet cable None of the above Take one of the following actions e If you did not yet power cycle the modem do so now a Unplug your modem s power leaving the modem connected to the wall jack for your Internet service If your modem includes a battery backup remove the battery Wait 10 seconds If your modem includes a battery backup reinsert the battery Plug in your modem s power and turn on your modem oe a0 5 Wait two minutes Select the I just power cycled the modem and waited for 2 minutes radio button Click the Next button gt e See if the DSL cable is not fully inserted or is inserted at the wrong place If necessary do the following Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 29 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Fully insert the DSL cable in the correct port on the modem and in the gray DSL port on the modem router b Select the I corrected a problem with the DSL Ethernet cable radio button c Click the Next button e If you do n
203. iles and folders on the device Back Up Windows Computers With ReadySHARE Vault Your modem router comes with free backup software for all the Windows computers in your home Connect a USB hard disk drive HDD or an eSATA storage device to the modem router for centralized continuous and automatic backup The following operating systems support ReadySHARE Vault Windows 7 Windows 8 Windows 8 1 Windows 10 Share a Storage Device 151 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To back up your Windows computer 1 2 Connect a USB or eSATA storage device to the appropriate port on the modem router If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the modem router When you connect the storage device to the modem router s port it might take up to two minutes before it is ready for sharing By default the device is available to all computers on your local area network LAN Download ReadySHARE Vault from netgear com readyshare and install it on each Windows computer Launch ReadySHARE Vault Use the dashboard or the Backup tab to set up and run your backup Back Up Mac Computers With Time Machine You can use Time Machine to back up your Mac computers onto a USB hard drive that is connected to one of the router s USB ports or an eSATA storage device connected to the router s eSATA port You can access the connected storage device from y
204. ine a custom service or application for each port triggering rule To add a port triggering rule 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 274 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Select the Port Triggering radio button Port Forwarding Port Triggering Apply gt Please select the service type Port Forwarding Port Triggering Disable Port Triggering Port Triggering Time out in minutes 20 Port Triggering Portmap Table Enable Service Name Service Type Inbound Connection Service User P Add Service f Edit Service x Delete Service 6 Click the Add Service button Port Triggering Services CCD E E Service Name Service User Any X Service Type TCP v Triggering Port 1 65535 Inbound Connection Connection Type TCP UDP v Starting Port 1 65535 Ending Port 1 65535 7 Specify a new port triggering rule with a custom service or application as described in the following table Fea peserion O O Enter the name of the custom servi
205. information in the following fields e Router s IPv6 Address On WAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s WAN or Internet interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available e Router s IPv6 Address On LAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s LAN interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available 6 In the Login field enter the login information for the ISP connection This is usually the name that you use in your email address For example if your main mail account is JerAB ISP com you would enter JerAB in this field Some ISPs such as Earthlink require that you use your full email address when you log in If your ISP requires your full email address enter it in this field In the Password field enter the password for the ISP connection In the Service Name If Required field enter a service name If your ISP did not provide a service name leave this field blank Manage the Internet Settings Manually 90 10 11 12 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Note The default setting of the Connection Mode menu is Always On to
206. interface and the Enable IPTV on LAN4 check box is automatically selected If you also connected an IPTV device to the LAN 3 port select the Enable IPTV on LAN3 check box If you also connected an IPTV device to the LAN 2 port select the Enable IPTV on LAN2 check box 10 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Enable and Configure a VLAN A network of computers and devices can behave as if they were connected to the same network even though they might actually be physically on different segments of a LAN Virtual LANs VLANs are configured through software rather than hardware which makes them very flexible Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 194 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you enable a VLAN and if the network devices hubs and switches on your LAN support the VLAN 802 1Q standard the VLAN ID is associated with all traffic coming from the modem router If you are subscribed to IPTV service the modem router might require VLAN tags to distinguish between the Internet traffic and the IPTV traffic For information about enabling and configuring the virtual IPTV interface see one of the following sections e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Noie If your ISP provides directions for how to set up VLANs for IPTV and Internet service fo
207. ion folder and click the Next button 1 Windows Security Would you like to install this device software Name TAP Windows Provider V9 Network adapters x Publisher OpenVPN Technologies Inc Always trust software from OpenVPN Install Don t Install Technologies Inc You should only install driver software from publishers you trust How can I decide which device software is safe to install 15 Click the Install button Use VPN to Access Your Network 260 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The window displays the progress of the installation and then displays the final installation window OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 Setup a fons Completing the OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 Setup Wizard OpenVPN 2 3 2 1003 has been installed on your computer Click Finish to dose this wizard Z Show Readme 16 Click the Finish button 17 Unzip the configuration files that you downloaded in Step 6 and copy them to the folder in which the OpenVPN client utility is installed on your computer If your device is a Windows 64 bit system the OpenVPN client utility is installed by default in the c Program files OpenVPN config folder 18 Modify the VPN interface name to NETGEAR VPN a In Windows select Start gt Control Panel gt Network and Internet gt Network Connections or Network and Sharing Center The network information displays b Inthe local area connection list find
208. ion on page 59 Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Specify an IPv6 Internet Connection on page 80 Manage the MTU Size on page 93 44 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Use the Internet Setup Wizard After Initial Setup Whether you use DSL service or cable or fiber service you can use the Setup Wizard to detect your Internet settings and automatically set up your modem router Note The Setup Wizard is the same as NETGEAR genie which launches the first time you connect to your modem router To use the Setup Wizard 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup Wizard Select Country Country USA X Select Internet Service Provider Internet Serice Provider Other s Do you want NETGEAR genie to help Yes want NETGEAR genie to determine the appropriate settings for my environment and configure my router automatically No want to manually enter configuration settings using the NETGEAR genie wizard Saved router settings want to load saved router configuration settings From the Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router
209. ired not only for a VC based connection but also for an LLC based connection Use VLANID Select the Use VLANID check box and enter the VLAN ID as indicated by your ISP A VLAN ID might be required if you subscribe to both Internet service and a service such as IPTV If your ISP did not provide you with a VLAN ID leave the Use VLANID check box cleared which is the default setting Priority 0 7 If your ISP provided you with a VLAN ID and a priority value enter the priority value which is a number from 0 to 7 You can enter a priority value only in combination with a VLAN ID If your ISP did not provide you with a priority value leave the default setting 0 Internet Service Provider Select the encapsulation as indicated by your ISP e PPPoA Your Internet connection uses PPP over ATM PPPOE Your Internet connection uses PPP over Ethernet Login Enter the login name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP This login name is often an email address Enter the password that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Service Name If Required Enter the service name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Often a service name is not required Manage the Internet Settings Manually 57 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e bea Connection Mode Select how the Internet connection functions
210. is complete the modem router reboots This process takes about two minutes WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the restoration For example do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 220 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Recover the admin Password We recommend that you enable password recovery if you change the password for the modem router user name admin Then you can recover the password if it is forgotten This recovery process is supported in Internet Explorer Firefox and Chrome browsers but not in the Safari browser For information about setting up password recovery see Set Up Password Recovery on page 41 The following procedure works only if you did set up password recovery To recover your password 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Click the Cancel button If password recovery is enabled you are prompted to enter the serial number of the modem router The serial number is on the product label of the modem router 4 Enter the serial number of the modem router Click the Continue button A page displays requesting the answers to your security questions
211. is connected to the Internet and synchronized its internal clock with a time server on the Internet For more information about whether the modem router synchronizes its clock see Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules on page 134 To set up the WiFi schedule 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 247 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Wireless Settings Advanced Wireless Settings CHD GEL Advanced Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n V Enable Wireless Router Radio V Enable 20 40 MHz Coexistence CTS RTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic y Transmit Power Control 100 v C Tur off wireless signal by schedule The wireless signal is scheduled to turn off during the following time period Period Start Ena Recurrence Pattern Add a new period Edit Delete Advanced Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac V Enable Wireless Router Radio CTSI RTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic z Transmit Power Control 100 v C Turn off wireless signal by schedule
212. is information to connect a WiFi device to the WiFi network of the modem router e Modem router login This logs you in to the modem router s web pages from a web browser as admin Automatic Internet Setup You can use NETGEAR genie to set up the modem router automatically or you can use the modem router s web pages to set up the modem router manually Automatic Internet setup with NETGEAR genie functions with both types of Internet service that the modem router supports e DSL service If you install your modem router for DSL service the modem router supports ADSL and VDSL service you can set up your modem router with NETGEAR genie which launches the first time that you set up the Internet connection for your modem router NETGEAR genie runs on any device with a web browser For more information see Set Up Your Modem Router for DSL Service on page 24 Cable or fiber service If you install your modem router for cable or fiber service you can set up your modem router with NETGEAR genie which launches the first time that you set up the Internet connection for your modem router NETGEAR genie runs on any device with a web browser For more information see Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber Service on page 32 Noie After initial installation and setup the NETGEAR Setup Wizard is always accessible to assist you with setting up an installation with DSL service or an installation with cable or fiber service For more infor
213. ive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 97 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select Wireless Wireless ttings Region Selection Region United States eea T Wireless Network 2 4GHz big n V Enable SSID Broadcast Name SSID NETGEAR84 Channel Auto v Mode Up to 800 Mbps Security Options None WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA IWPA2 Enterprise Security Options WPA2 PSK Password Network Key calmfire842 8 63 characters or 64 hex digits Wireless Network 5GHz 802 11a n ac V Enable SSID Broadcast Enable Video Network Name SSID NETGEAR84 5G Channel 44 v Mode Up to 1733 Mbps Security Options None WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA WPA2 Enterprise Security Options WPA2 PSK Password Network Key calmfire842 8 63 characters or 64 hex digits 5 View or change the basic WiFi settings and security settings The following table describes the fields on the Wireless Settings page e p Region Selection Region From the menu select the region in which the modem router operates Note It might not be legal to operate the modem router in a region other than the regions listed in the menu If your country or region is not listed check with your local government agency Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 98 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 f
214. ive you a specific host name you can leave this field blank To specify a domain name in the Domain Name If Required field enter a domain name If your ISP gave you a specific domain name enter it in this field For example Earthlink Cable might require a host name of home and Comcast sometimes supplies a domain name If your ISP did not give you a specific domain name you can either leave this field blank or enter the domain name of your IPv6 ISP Do not enter the domain name for the IPv4 ISP here For example if your ISP s mail server is mail xxx yyy zzz enter xxx yyy zzz as the domain name Select an IP Address Assignment radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPVv6 client function This is the default setting e Auto Config The modem router automatically configures its IPv6 address based on the IPv6 protocol Manage the Internet Settings Manually 88 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 9 To specify the interface ID for the IPv6 address of the modem router s LAN interface select the Use This Interface ID check box and enter the interface ID If you do not specify an ID here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address 10 Select the IPv6 filtering mode e Secured
215. k name for the 2 4 GHz band of the guest network Wireless AP Displays whether the 2 4 GHz band of the guest network is enabled The WiFi LED on the front of the modem router is not affected by the status of the guest network Broadcast Name Displays whether the 2 4 GHz band of the guest network broadcasts its SSID Allow guests to see each other and Displays whether users of the 2 4 GHz band of the guest network are allowed to access access my local network the main network Guest Network 5 0GHz The settings of the WiFi port for the 5 GHz band of the guest network For information about how to configure the settings of the guest network see Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Guest Network on page 110 Name SSID The WiFi network name for the 5 GHz band of the guest network Wireless AP Displays whether the 2 4 GHz band of the main network is enabled Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 228 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Broadcast Name Displays whether the 5 GHz band of the guest network broadcasts its SSID Allow guests to see each other and Displays whether users of the 5 GHz band of the guest network are allowed to access access my local network the main network View the Traffic Statistics You can view the traffic statistics for the ports of the modem router To view the traffic statistics for the ports of the modem router 1 2 L
216. king the Connect button If the PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP connection is not working make sure that your service name user name and password are set correctly Or your ISP might not be able to provide an Internet connection For more information see one of the following sections Specify an ADSL Connection With a Login and PPPoA or PPPoE Service on page 55 Specify a VDSL Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service on page 64 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service on page 72 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPTP or L2TP Service on page 77 Troubleshoot Internet Browsing If your modem router can obtain an IP address but your computer is unable to load any web pages from the Internet it might be for one of the following reasons The traffic meter is enabled and the limit was reached By configuring the traffic meter not to block Internet access when the traffic limit is reached you can resume Internet access see Unblock the Traffic Meter After the Traffic Limit Is Reached on page 243 If your ISP sets a usage limit they might charge you for the overage Your computer might not recognize any DNS server addresses A DNS server is a host on the Internet that translates Internet names Such as www addresses to numeric IP addresses Typically your ISP provides the addresses of one or two DNS servers for your use If you entered a DNS address when you set up the modem router reboot your compu
217. l lll 27960 27960 192 168 1 100 192 168 1 199 The previous figure shows two rules in the Service Table In the Service Table select the radio button for the rule Click the Delete button The rule is removed from the Service Table Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules You can set up a schedule that you can apply to keyword blocking see Use Keywords to Block Internet Sites on page 124 and outbound firewall rules see Manage Simple Outbound Firewall Rules for Services and Applications on page 128 If applied the schedule specifies the days and time that keyword blocking outbound firewall rules or both are active Control Access to the Internet 134 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 By default no schedule is set and you can either enable or disable these features To set up a schedule for blocking 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Schedule Schedule RPP EEE ELD Days to Block Every Day Sunday Monday Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday Saturday Time of day to block use 24 hour clock V All Day Start B
218. lease select the service type Port Forwarding Port Triggering Service Name Server IP Address FTP rA 192 168 1 k Add ServiceName External Start Port External End Port Internal Start Port Internal End Port Internal IP address 1 IP_Phone 6670 6670 6670 6670 192 168 1 15 2 Quakell ill 27960 27960 27960 27960 192 168 1 213 Add Custom Service The previous figure shows two custom port forwarding rules Make sure that the Port Forwarding radio button is selected In the table select the radio button next to the service or application name Click the Edit Service button The Ports Custom Services page displays Change the settings For information about the settings see Add a Port Forwarding Rule With a Custom Service or Application on page 269 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The changed rule displays in the table on the Port Forwarding Port Triggering page Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 271 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Remove a Port Forwarding Rule You can remove a port forwarding rule that you no longer need To remove a port forwarding rule 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive
219. lect ADVANCED gt Administration gt Logs GD GED ET ELED Current Time Monday Aug 31 2015 19 58 40 Time synchronized with NIP server Monday August 31 2015 19 57 52 Internet connected IP address 192 168 100 168 Monday August 31 2015 19 57 40 admin login from source 192 168 1 2 Monday August 31 2015 19 54 54 admin login from source 192 168 1 2 Monday August 31 2015 19 38 19 DHCP IP 192 168 1 2 to MAC address 60 66 66 da 66 7c Monday August 31 2015 19 37 00 Initialized firmware version V1 0 0 38 Monday August 31 2015 19 35 46 IV Attempted access to allowed sites V Attempted access to blocked sites and services Connections to the Web based interface of this Router V Router Operation startup get time etc F Known DoS attacks and Port Scans V Port Forwarding Port Triggering V Wireless access E Turn off wireless signal by schedule E ReadySHARE V VPN Service The Logs page shows the following information Action The action that occurred such as whether Internet access was blocked or allowed Source The name IP address or MAC address of the target device application or website for this log entry Target The name IP address or MAC address of the target device application or website for this log entry Date and Time The date and time at which the action occurred To refresh the log entries onscreen click the Refresh button To email the log immed
220. lected We recommend that you leave this check box selected If you clear this check box the next time a new WiFi client uses WPS to connect to the modem router the modem router WiFi settings change to an automatically generated random SSID and passphrase For information about viewing this SSID and passphrase see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 Clear the Keep Existing Wireless Settings check box only if you want to allow the WPS process to change the SSID and passphrase for WiFi access WARNING If you clear the Keep Existing Wireless Settings check box and use WPS to add a computer or WiFi device to the modem router s WiFi network the SSID and passphrase are automatically generated and other WiFi devices that are already connected to the modem router s WiFi network might be disconnected Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage Advanced WiFi Settings For most WiFi networks the advanced WiFi settings work fine and you do not need to change the settings Tip If you want to change the WiFi settings of the modem router s main network use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when the new WiFi settings take effect To manage advanced WiFi features 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default pa
221. led to turn off during the following time period Add a new period Edit Delete Advanced Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac V Enable Wireless Router Radio CTSIRTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic X Transmit Power Control 100 v Turn off wireless signal by schedule The wireless signal is scheduled to turn off during the following time period Period Start Ena Recurrence Patten Add a new period Edit Delete 5 Doone of the following in the Advanced Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n section Advanced Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac section or both sections Turn off the radio Clear the Enable Wireless Router Radio check box The 2 4 GHz WiFi LED 5 GHz WiFi LED WiFi LED and WPS LED turn off e Turn on the radio Select the Enable Wireless Router Radio check box The 2 4 GHz WiFi LED 5 GHz WiFi LED WiFi LED and WPS LED lights solid white 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 116 Control Access to the Internet 5 The modem router comes with a built in firewall that helps protect your home network from unwanted intrusions from the Internet This chapter includes the following sections e Set Up Parental Controls on page 118 e Allow or Block Access to Your Network on page 119 e Use Keywords to Block Internet Sites on page 124 e Manage Simple Outbound Firewall Rules for Services and Applications on page 128 e Set Up a Schedule f
222. limit is specified and the traffic volume is not controlled In the Traffic Counter section set the traffic counter to begin at a specific time and date To start the traffic counter immediately click the Restart Counter Now button Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts The Internet Traffic Statistics section helps you to monitor the data traffic For more information see View the Internet Traffic Volume and Statistics on page 238 View the Internet Traffic Volume and Statistics If you enabled the traffic meter see Start the Traffic Meter Without Traffic Volume Restrictions on page 237 you can view the Internet traffic volume and statistics Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 238 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To view the Internet traffic volume and statistics of the traffic meter 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Traffic Meter The Traffic Meter page displays 5 Scroll down to the Internet Traffic Statistics section Internet Traffic Statistics Start Date Time Monday 22 Jun 2015 10 10 AM C
223. llow those directions t To enable and configure a VLAN for the virtual Internet interface and another VLAN for the virtual IPTV interface 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 195 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select Internet Internet Setup GD OCZ ENEL Select Country Germany X Select Internet Service Provider Deutsche Telekom v Transfer Mode VDSL PTM v DSL Mode VDSL2 v Internet v V Enable This Interface Multiplexing Method LLC BASED VPI 8 vel 35 Use VLANID 7 Priority 0 7 o Configure a VLAN for the virtual Internet interface a Make sure that Internet is selected from the menu above the Enable This Interface check box and that the Enable This Interface check box is selected for the virtual Internet interface it is by default b Select the Use VLANID check box c Enter a VLAN ID that applies to the virtual Internet interface The VLAN ID can be in a range from 0 to 4094 The default VLAN ID is 10 d To specify a priority for the VLAN in the Priority 0 7 field enter a value from 0 to 7 e Click the Apply button Your settings are s
224. locking O Houro Minute End Blocking 24 Hour oO Minute Time Zone GMT 08 00 Pacific Time US amp Canada Tijuana X Automatically adjust for daylight savings time Current Time Friday 20 Mar 2015 05 29 14 5 Set up the schedule for blocking e Days to Block Select the check box for each day that you want to block access or specify that blocking occurs on every day by selecting the Every Day check box By default the Every Day check box is selected Time of Day to Block Select a start and end time for blocking in 24 hour format or select the All Day check box for 24 hour blocking By default the All Day check box is selected 6 From the Time Zone menu select your time zone Control Access to the Internet 135 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you live in an area that observes daylight saving time select the Automatically adjust for daylight savings time check box Note Ifthe modem router synchronized its internal clock with a time server on the Internet and you selected the correct time zone the Current Time field displays the correct date and time Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up Security Event Email Notifications The modem router can email you its logs of its activity The log records router activity and security events such as attempts to access blocked sites or services To set up email notifications 1 2 Launch a web browser from
225. ls the modem router overwrites the log Control Access to the Internet 138 Optimize Performance 5 This chapter describes how you can optimize the modem router s performance and manage the traffic flows through the modem router The chapter contains the following sections e Use Dynamic QoS to Optimize Internet Traffic Management on page 140 e Manage Wi Fi Multimedia Quality of Service on page 144 e Manage Beamforming on page 146 e Improve Network Connections With Universal Plug and Play on page 146 139 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Use Dynamic QoS to Optimize Internet Traffic Management Dynamic Quality of Service QoS helps improve your router s Internet traffic management capabilities through better application and device identification bandwidth allocation and traffic prioritization techniques Dynamic QoS resolves traffic congestion when the Internet bandwidth is limited and different demands compete for bandwidth If your Internet download and upload speed is 250 Mbps or less and you like gaming and streaming video then you can benefit from enabling Dynamic QoS Note If you use a Gigabit Internet connection or your Internet download and upload speed is 300 Mbps or faster then you don t need to use Dynamic QoS Downstream QoS video streaming Internet t F LI Upstream QoS gaming Figure 9 Dynamic QoS optimizes Internet traffic by prioritizing competing de
226. lt in a solid white DSL Internet LED a problem with your wiring might exist If the telephone company tested the DSL signal at your network interface device NID then wiring in your house might be of poor quality DSL Internet LED Is Off If the DSL Internet LED amp is off the modem router cannot connect to the Internet or to your Internet service provider ISP To resolve the problem you can try the following steps To reenable the modem router to connect to the Internet or your ISP 1 If you are using a DSL connection to your ISP do the following a Disconnect all telephones on the line If this solves the problem reconnect the telephones one at a time being sure to use a microfilter on each telephone If the microfilters are connected correctly you can connect all your telephones b Check to see that the telephone company made the connection to your line and tested it c Verify that you are connected to the correct telephone line If more than one phone line is installed be sure that you are connected to the line with the DSL service It might be necessary to use a swapper if your DSL signal is on pins 1 and 4 or the RJ 11 jack The modem router uses pins 2 and 3 2 If you are using a cable or fiber connection to your ISP check to see if all cable connections between the modem router and the cable or fiber modem are good All cables should be fully inserted in the ports 3 Check to see that your login credentials are cor
227. m router i 2 3 4 Visit the NETGEAR genie web page at netgear com genie Click the appropriate Download button Follow the onscreen instructions to install the app on your smartphone tablet or computer Launch the genie app The genie app dashboard displays The following figure shows the genie app dashboard for a Windows computer ETGEAR genie Select Language Wireless Network M rome Internet fa aS 4 WiFi Connection lt 9 l i l Router Settings AI aa Network Map Internet WiFi Connection Router Settings Parental Controls il STATUS GOOD STATUS Connected Click here ReadySHARE AirPrint my le oe Network Map Parental Controls Ready SHARE Number of devices 7 Click here Click here Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 43 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 3 This chapter describes how you can manage the Internet settings of the modem router manually Usually the quickest way to set up the modem router is to allow NETGEAR genie to detect the Internet connection when you first access the modem router with a web browser These options are described in nstall and Access the Modem Router and Its Network on page 19 You can also customize or specify your Internet settings manually The chapter contains the following sections Use the Internet Setup Wizard After Initial Setup on page 45 Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connect
228. mands Enable Dynamic QoS Because not everyone uses Dynamic QoS it is disabled by default To enable Dynamic QoS 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Optimize Performance 140 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select Quality of Service QoS Setup lt a Dynamic QoS Automatic traffic prioritization by application and device QoS does not increase your total Internet bandwidth or WiFi throughput Internet Bandwidth Let Speedtest detect my Internet bandwidth recommended DOWNLOAD SPEED UPLOAD SPEED yr 4 Mbps Mbp OOICLA Speedtest want to define my Internet bandwidth Performance Optimization Database V Automatically update performance optimization database Version v 30 960029a 7 Release Date March 30 2015 Help improve the Quality of Service feature by sharing analytics with NETGEAR Click here to learn more about how we collect use and share analytics information 5 Specify your Internet bandwidth You must specify your Internet bandwidth so that Dynamic QoS can perform bandwidth allocation and traffic prioritization To allow Speedtest to detect your Intern
229. mation see Use the Internet Setup Wizard After Initial Setup on page 45 Whether you install your modem router for DSL service or for cable or fiber service you can always use the modem router s web pages to set up the modem router manually Before you start the setup process get your ISP information and make sure that the settings that are described here are specified for the computers and devices in the network When your Internet service starts your Internet service provider ISP typically gives you all the information that you need to connect to the Internet For DSL service you might need the following information to set up your modem router e The ISP configuration information for your DSL account e ISP login name and password Fixed or static IP address settings special deployment by ISP this setting is rare Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 23 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you cannot locate this information ask your ISP to provide it When your Internet connection is working you no longer need to launch the ISP login program on your computer to access the Internet When you start an Internet application your modem router automatically logs you in Set Up Your Modem Router for DSL Service You can install your modem router for DSL service or for cable or fiber Ethernet WAN service If you use a DSL modem follow the procedure that is described in Cable the Mod
230. me is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Media Server The Media Server Settings page displays 5 Click the Rescan media files button The modem router rescans for content Play Music From a Storage Device With iTunes Server iTunes Server lets you play music with your Windows or Mac iTunes app from a storage device that is connected to the modem router You can also use the Apple Remote app from an iPhone or iPad to play music on any AirPlay devices such as Apple TV or AirPlay supported receivers Figure 13 Play music on a USB device with iTunes Supported music file formats are MP3 AAC and FLAC The maximum number of music files supported is 10 000 Use the Modem Router as a Media Server 178 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To specify iTunes server settings 1 2 3 On your iPhone or iPad find and connect to the WiFi network Launch the Remote app Tap the Add a Device button A passcode displays Specify the passcode in the modem router a Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network b Enter http Awww routerlogin net o gt A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive
231. modem router does not process any IPv6 header packets Note Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you To set up an IPv6 pass through Internet connection 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays From the Internet Connection Type menu select Pass Through The page adjusts but no additional fields display Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 Fixed Connection A fixed IPv6 connection is based on a static or fixed IPv6 address that your IPv6 ISP gave you Note Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you h To set up a fixed IPv6 Internet connection 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net Manage the Internet Settings Manually 85 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced S
232. modem router for two seconds If you turned off the WiFi radios the 2 4 GHz WiFi LED 5 GHz WiFi LED WiFi LED and WPS LED turn off If you turned on the WiFi radios these LEDs lights solid white Tip If you want to disable the WiFi radio or radios of the modem router use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when WiFi radio or radios turn off Enable or Disable the WiFi Radios If you used the WiFi On Off button to turn off the WiFi radios you cannot log in to the modem router to turn them back on You must press the WiFi On Off button again for two seconds to turn the WiFi radios back on To enable or disable the WiFi radios 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 115 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Wireless Settings Advanced Wireless Settings Advanced Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n V Enable Wireless Router Radio Y Enable 20 40 MHz Coexistence CTSIRTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic v Transmit Power Control 100 v Turn off wireless signal by schedule The wireless signal is schedu
233. n The page adjusts Change the settings for the route For more information about the settings see Set Up a Static Route on page 212 Click the Apply button The route is updated in the table on the Static Routes page Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 214 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Remove a Static Route You can remove an existing static route that you no longer need To remove a static route 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Static Routes The Static Routes page displays In the Static Routes table select the radio button to the left of the route Click the Delete button The route is removed from the table on the Static Routes page Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 215 Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the 1 2 Traffic This chapter describes how you can manage the settings for administering and maintaining your modem router and monitor the network The chapter includes the following sections e Update the Firmware of the Modem Router on page 217 e Manage the Configuration File of the Modem Router on page 219
234. n Your settings are saved Click the For Windows or For non Windows button and download the configuration files for your VPN clients Unzip the configuration files and copy them to the folder where the VPN client is installed on your device For a client device with Windows 64 bit system the VPN client is installed at c Program files OpenVPN config by default Block VPN Client Internet Access in the Modem Router By default the modem router is set up to allow VPN connections only to your home network not to the Internet service for your home network If you changed this setting to allow Internet access you can change it back To allow VPN clients to access only your home network 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Use VPN to Access Your Network 265 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VPN Service The VNP page displays Select the Enable VPN Service radio button Scroll down to the Clients will use this VPN connection to access section and select the Home Network only radio button Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Use a VPN Tunn
235. n automatically IPv6 Internet Connections and IPv6 Addresses The modem router can support an IPv6 Internet connection through the following connection types Auto Detect For more information see Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Detect on page 81 6to4 tunnel For more information see Set Up an IPv6 6to4 Tunnel Connection on page 83 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 80 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e Pass through For more information see Set Up an Pv6 Pass Through Connection on page 85 e Fixed For more information see Set Up an IPv6 Fixed Connection on page 85 DHCP For more information see Set Up an IPv6 DHCP Connection on page 87 PPP over Ethernet For more information see Set Up an IPv6 PPPoE Connection on page 89 e Auto Config For more information see Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Config on page 91 Which connection type you must use depends on your IPv6 ISP Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you e If your ISP did not provide details use the 6to4 tunnel connection type see Set Up an IPv6 6to4 Tunnel Connection on page 83 e If you are not sure what type of IPv6 connection the modem router uses use the Auto Detect connection type which lets the modem router detect the IPv6 type that is in use see Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Detect on page 81 e If your Internet connection does not use PPPoE DHCP a fixed IP address o
236. n set limits for traffic volume set a monthly limit and get a live update of traffic usage Start the Traffic Meter Without Traffic Volume Restrictions You can monitor the traffic volume without setting a limit To start or restart the traffic meter without configuring traffic volume restrictions l 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 237 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Traffic Meter Traffic Meter CCZ ELE Internet Traffic Meter Enable Traffic Meter Traffic volume control by No limit Monthly limit 0 Mbytes Round up data volume for each connection by 0 Mbytes Connection time control Monthly limit 0 Hours Traffic Counter Restart traffic counter at 0 300 am Onthe ist day of each month Restart Counter Now Traffic Control Pop up a warning message 0 Mbytes Minutes before the monthly limit is reached When the monthly limit is reached Turn the Internet LED to flashing white amber Disconnect and disable the Internet connection 5 Select the Enable Traffic Meter check box By default no traffic
237. n this manual referred to as the modem router delivers combined WiFi connection speeds of up to approximately AC2600 WiFi 800 Mbps on 2 4 GHz 802 11n and 1733 Mbps on 5 GHz 802 11ac Both the 2 4 GHz and 5 GHz radios can be active simultaneously The Nighthawk X4S is ideal for homes with a high volume of network and Internet traffic from gaming and streaming It supports the following advanced features e Multi user MIMO MU MIMO for faster speeds with simultaneously streamed data for up to three devices e Quad Stream WiFi for up to four data streams per WiFi band to maximize connection speed e Dynamic QoS for performance optimization based on applications and devices with automatic cloud updates to optimize the most popular applications and services The Nighthawk X4S also provides fast central storage backup and streaming to every device in your home with two USB 3 0 ports 10 times faster than USB 2 0 and an eSATA port Sharing content across your network is easy whether you are accessing stored photos and music or printing over WiFi Stream your stored media files on any device anywhere on the network Share your music with AirPlay compatible devices from a USB hard drive connected to the modem router Use the free NETGEAR ReadySHARE Vault app to back up your Windows computers to a USB hard drive connected to the Nighthawk X4S The modem router is compatible with most major DSL Internet service providers and also supports cable or fi
238. name If you did not change the SSID the default SSID Name SSID displays which is NETGEAR Guest To change the SSID in the 2 4 GHz WiFi band for the guest WiFi network enter a 32 character maximum case sensitive name in this field Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 112 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Be ee Security Options If you want to change the WiFi security select one of the following WiFi security options for the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network e None An open WiFi network that does not provide any security Any WiFi device can join the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network This is the default setting for the guest WiFi network WEP Wired Equivalent Privacy WEP security is a legacy authentication and data encryption mode that is superseded by WPA PSK and WPA2 PSK The WEP option displays only if you configure the WiFi mode for the main WiFi network as Up to 54 Mbps in the 2 4 GHz band see View or Change the Basic WiFi Settings on page 97 For information about configuring WEP see Configure WEP Legacy WiFi Security on page 106 WPA2 PSK AES WPA2 provides a secure and fast connection but some older WiFi devices do not detect WPA2 and support only WPA Select WPA2 PSK AES security to allow 802 11n devices to connect to the 2 4 GHz band of the guest WiFi network at the fastest speed If your network includes older devices that do not support WPA2 select WPA PSK TKIP
239. name for the VLAN tag group The name can be up to 10 characters Enter a value from 1 to 4094 Priority Enter a value from 0 to 7 Select the check box for a wired LAN port or WiFi port If your device is connected to an Ethernet port on the modem router select the LAN port check box that corresponds to the Ethernet port on the modem router to which the device is connected If your device is connected to your modem router s WiFi network select the WiFi check box that corresponds to the modem router s WiFi network to which the device is connected You must select at least one LAN port or WiFi port You can select more than one port 8 Click the Add button The VLAN tag group is added 9 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the WAN Security Settings The WAN security settings include port scan protection and denial of service DoS protection which can protect your LAN against attacks such as Syn flood Smurf Attack Ping of Death and many others By default DoS protection is enabled and a port scan is rejected You can also enable the modem router to respond to a ping to its WAN Internet port This feature allows your modem router to be discovered Enable this feature only as a diagnostic tool or if a specific reason exists To change the default WAN security settings 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin
240. nd for the guest WiFi network clear the Enable SSID Broadcast check box Allow guests to see each By default WiFi clients that are connected to the 5 GHz WiFi band of the guest WiFi network other and access my local cannot access WiFi devices or Ethernet devices that are connected to the main WiFi network network To allow access to the main WiFi network select the Allow guests to see each other and access my local network check box Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 113 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Bse een Guest Wireless Network The SSID is the 5 GHz WiFi band name If you did not change the SSID the default SSID Name SSID displays which is NETGEAR 5G Guest To change the SSID in the 5 GHz WiFi band for the guest WiFi network enter a 32 character maximum case sensitive name in this field Security Options If you want to change the WiFi security select one of the following WiFi security options for the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network e None An open WiFi network that does not provide any security Any WiFi device can join the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network This is the default setting for the guest WiFi network WPA2 PSK AES WPA2 provides a secure and fast connection but some older WiFi devices do not detect WPA2 and support only WPA Select WPA2 PSK AES security to allow 802 11ac and 802 11n devices to connect to the 5 GHz band of the guest WiFi network at th
241. nd the SSID to which the device is connected point to the device icon 6 To change the device name device type or both do the following Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 234 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Click the device icon The Edit Device page displays b To change the device name in the Device Name field type a new device name The new device name is for display on the modem router only c To change the device type from the Device Type menu select another device type The device icon changes d Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage the Activity Log The log is a detailed record of the websites users on your network accessed or attempted to access and many other modem router actions Up to 256 entries are stored in the log You can manage which activities are logged View the Logs In addition to viewing the logs you can email them and clear them To view email or clear the logs 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 235 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Se
242. ndwidth Let Speedtest detect my Internet bandwidth recommended DOWNLOAD SPEED UPLOAD SPEED open wv Y Mbps A Mbp OOKKLA want to define my Internet bandwidth Performance Optimization Database Automatically update performance optimization database Current Pe ce Optimization Database on Router ver niv Release Date March 2015 Help improve the Quality of Service feature by sharing analytics with NETGEAR Click here to learn more about how we collect use and share analytics information If you are using Dynamic QoS the Dynamic QoS check box is selected 5 Make sure that you enabled Dynamic QoS For more information about enabling Dynamic QoS see Enable Dynamic QoS on page 140 6 Click the Click here to learn more about how we collect use and share analytics information link A pop up window displays detailed information about sharing analytics The Yes radio button is selected by default 7 After you read the information click the Submit button The pop up window closes and the Help improve the Dynamic QoS feature by sharing analytics with NETGEAR check box is selected automatically 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage Wi Fi Multimedia Quality of Service Wi Fi Multimedia Quality of Service WMM QoS prioritizes WiFi voice and video traffic over the WiFi link Optimize Performance 144 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 WMM QoS pri
243. nection IP Subnet Mask The IP subnet mask that the Internet port uses The IP address of the Domain Name System DNS server that the Internet uses Wireless Settings 2 4GHz The settings of the WiFi port for the 2 4 GHz band of the main network For information about how to configure the settings of the main network see the following sections e Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network on page 97 Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 Name SSID The WiFi network name for the 2 4 GHz band of the main network The channel that the 2 4 GHz band of the main network uses Mode The WiFi Mbps settings that the 2 4 GHz band uses for both the main network and guest network Wireless AP Displays whether the 2 4 GHz band of the main network is enabled Broadcast Name Displays whether the 2 4 GHz band of the main network broadcasts its SSID Wi Fi Protected Setup Displays whether the modem router keeps its existing WiFi settings when you use WPS to connect a device to the 2 4 GHz band of the main network e Configured The modem router keeps its existing WiFi settings This is the default setting Not configured The modem router generates a random SSID and passphrase and changes the security mode to WPA WPA2 PSK mixed mode For more information see Manage the WPS Settings on page 249 Wireless Settings 5 0GHz The settings of the WiFi port for the 5 GHz band of the main network For information about how t
244. net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 201 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The WAN Setup page displays To enable a port scan and disable DoS protection select the Disable Port Scan and DoS Protection check box To enable the modem router to respond to a ping select the Respond to Ping on Internet Port check box Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up a Default DMZ Server The default DMZ server feature is helpful when you are using some online games and videoconferencing applications that are incompatible with Network Address Translation NAT The modem router is programmed to recognize some of these applications and to work correctly with them but other applications might not function well In some cases one local computer can run the application correctly if the IP address for that computer is entered as the default DMZ server WARNING DMZ servers pose a security risk A computer designated as the default DMZ server loses much of the protection of the firewall and is exposed to exploits from the Internet If compromised the DMZ server computer can be used to attack other computers on your network The modem rout
245. nge If you set up Dynamic DNS see Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS on page 168 you can also type a URL domain name For example if your domain name is MyName and you use the NETGEAR DDNS server you can type ftp MyName mynetgear com to access the USB device over the Internet and download or upload files 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Share a Storage Device 156 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Enable FTP Access Within Your Network File Transfer Protocol FTP lets you download receive and upload send large files faster Note For information about using FTP to access a storage device over the Internet see Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet on page 167 To enable FTP access within your network 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Apply gt Network Device Name o7s00 C Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port T Network Neighborhood MacShare 107800 v HTTP http readyshare routerlogin nevshares 80 A HTTP via internet 192 168 1
246. nicaaueanieees 203 Manage the SIP Application Level Gateway c ccceceeseceeeeeteeeeeeeeneeeeteeneeees 204 Manage the Modem Router s LAN IP Address SettingS eeeeseeeeeeeees 205 Manage the Router Information Protocol SettingS cceceseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 206 Manage the DHCP Server Address POol ccccseccceseseceeeeeeeeeeeeesneeeeneeneeees 207 Manage Reserved LAN IP AddreSSes 2 ccceeeecceeeeeneeeeeeesaaeeeeesneeeseenseeees 208 Reserve a LAN IP AdGreSS os ccicctsssniiscsnicicenctivedecsanerapientenciactbicinetanteennnwaraces 208 Change a Reserved IP ACOreSS cccccsccceeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeenaeeeetenneeees 209 Remove a Reserved IP Address Entry cccssseeeeeeeeeeceeeesaceeeeesseeeeeneaas 210 Disable the Built In DHCP Server c cccsicsscscccstescenceesscenesescbacenmssdenenssesnneeneevchetennes 210 Change the Modem Router s Device Name cccccccceceeeeeeeeteeeesseneeeeeneeas 211 Set Up and Manage Custom Static ROUtES ccccccccceccesseeeeeeeeeeeesesneeeeeees 212 Set Up 4 Static ROUE kepice annn R E E E RE RE 212 Change a Static Route esneeeeseeesserrreererrertttressrrrnrertnntrsrtentsrrrrnsrnnn nennen 214 Remove a Static POU viiccisentceciecsacucsaacicusntenmminnnecruniniacnnaraeneatienewaies 215 Chapter 12 Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic Update the Firmware of the Modem Routel ccccceeecceeeeeeeeee
247. nt radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPv6 client function This is the default setting e Auto Config The modem router automatically configures its IPv6 address based on the IPv6 protocol In the IPv6 Address Prefix Length fields specify the static IPv6 address and prefix length of the modem router s LAN interface If you do not specify an address here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address Select the IPv6 filtering mode e Secured In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 DHCP Connection An IPv6 DHCP connection is based on a dynamic IPv6 address that a DHCPV6 server assigns to the modem router Note Follow the directions that your IPv6 ISP gave you To set up an IPv6 Internet connection with a DHCP server 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive
248. o configure the settings of the main network see the following sections Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network on page 97 Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 227 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a ea fd Name SSID The WiFi network name for the 5 GHz band of the main network The channel that the 5 GHz band of the main network uses Mode The WiFi Mbps settings that the 5 GHz band uses for both the main network and guest network Wireless AP Displays whether the 5 GHz band of the main network is enabled Broadcast Name Displays whether the 5 GHz band of the main network broadcasts its SSID Wi Fi Protected Setup Displays whether the modem router keeps its existing WiFi settings when you use WPS to connect a device to the 5 GHz band of the main network e Configured The modem router keeps its existing WiFi settings This is the default setting Not configured The modem router generates a random SSID and passphrase and changes the security mode to WPA WPA2 PSK mixed mode For more information see Manage the WPS Settings on page 249 Guest Network 2 4GHz The settings of the WiFi port for the 2 4 GHz band of the guest network For information about how to configure the settings of the guest network see Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Guest Network on page 110 Name SSID The WiFi networ
249. oes not match what is described in this guide you might need to update your firmware Note In this manual the terms wireless and WiFi are interchangeable 10 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Unpack Your Modem Router Your package contains the following items Figure 1 Package contents for the modem router Table 1 Legend Antennas 4 Power supply varies by region DSL microfilter varies by region Ethernet cable Phone cable Your package might contain more items The filter or phone cable provided depends on the region In some regions a CD is included in the package Attach the Antennas The modem router comes with four antennas Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 11 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To attach the antennas 1 To determine where to attach the antennas match the labels on the antennas with the labels on the modem router LL EEN Align the antennas with the antenna posts on the modem router Attach the antennas on the threaded antenna posts Position the antennas for the best WiFi performance We recommend that you position all of the antennas vertically as shown Top Panel With LEDs The status LEDs and buttons are located on the top panel of the modem router Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 12 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 NETGEAR Figure 2 LEDs and buttons
250. oid VPN client software VPN uses DDNS or a static IP address to connect with your modem router To use a DDNS service register for an account with a host name sometimes called a domain name You use the host name to access your network The modem router supports these accounts NETGEAR No IP and Dyn See Set Up and Manage Dynamic DNS on page 168 If your Internet service provider ISP assigned a static WAN IP address such as 50 196 x x or 10 x x x that never changes to your Internet account the VPN can use that IP address to connect to your home network Specify VPN Service in the Modem Router You must specify the VPN service settings in the modem router before you can use a VPN connection To specify the VPN service 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VPN Service The VPN Service page displays 5 Select the Enable VPN Service check box By default the VPN uses the UDP service type and uses port 12974 If you want to customize the service type and port we recommend that you change these settings before you install the OpenVPN software To change the service type scroll down and select
251. on see one of the following sections e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Verify the PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP Connection If you use a PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP connection to your ISP make sure that the connection works To verify that your PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP connection is working T 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays In the Internet Port pane check to see that the IP Address field shows a valid IP address and that the Connection field shows the protocol that your connection is using PPPoE PPPoA PPTP or L2TP In the Internet Port pane click the Connection Status button The Connection Status page displays Check the following e The Connection Status field shows Connected Troubleshooting 289 8 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e The Connection Time field does not show 00 00 00 If the Connection Status field does not show Connected try to reconnect by clic
252. on Both z RIP Version Disabled v Use Router as DHCP Server Starting IP Address 192 168 1 2 Ending IP Address 192 168 1 254 Address Reservation IP Address Device Name MAC Address In the IP Address field enter the LAN IP address for the modem router Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 205 6 7 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In the IP Subnet Mask enter the LAN subnet mask for the modem router Click the Apply button Your settings are saved If you changed the LAN IP address of the modem router you are disconnected when the changes take effect To reconnect close your browser relaunch it and log in to the modem router at its new LAN IP address Manage the Router Information Protocol Settings Router Information Protocol RIP lets the modem router exchange routing information with other routers By default RIP is enabled in both directions in and out without a particular RIP version bh To manage the RIP settings 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays From the RIP Direction menu sele
253. on applies to the 5 GHz WiFi network Note We recommend that you do not change your preset security settings WPA2 PSK AES If you must change the WiFi security select one of the following WiFi security options for the modem router s WiFi network e None An open WiFi network that does not provide any security Any WiFi device can join the network We recommend that you do not use an open WiFi network WPA2 PSK AES This option is the default setting This type of security enables WiFi devices that support WPA2 to join the modem router s 5 GHz WiFi network If you did not change the passphrase the default passphrase displays The default passphrase is printed on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 WPA2 provides a secure connection but some older WiFi devices do not detect WPA2 and support only WPA If your network includes such older devices select WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES security We recommend that you do not change the default passphrase If you must change the passphrase in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES This type of security enables WiFi devices that support either WPA or WPA2 to join the modem router s 5 GHz WiFi network However WPA PSK TKIP is less secure than WPA2 PSK AES and limits the speed of WiFi devices to 54 Mbps To use this type of security
254. onnection settings manually The following sections describe the options that are available to you to manually set up the VDSL Internet connection e Specify a VDSL Connection Without a Login on page 59 e Specify a VDSL Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service on page 64 Note Some ISPs require that you register on their website before you can obtain Internet service Follow the directions that your ISP gave you Specify a VDSL Connection Without a Login If you want to manually configure the VDSL connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet Note Some ISPs support two virtual interfaces one Internet virtual interface and one IPTV virtual interface Before you specify the settings for the IPTV interface first use the following procedure to specify the settings for the Internet interface Then repeat the procedure to specify the settings for the IPTV interface While doing so follow the directions that your ISP gave you Manage the Internet Settings Manually 59 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To view or specify the settings for a VDSL Internet connection that does not require a login fi 2 9 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www
255. or Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules on page 134 e Set Up Security Event Email Notifications on page 136 For information about more advanced ways to configure Internet security see Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering on page 267 117 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Set Up Parental Controls The first time that you select Parental Controls from the BASIC Home page your browser goes to the Parental Controls website You can learn more about parental controls or download the application After you set up and enable parental controls you can change the web filtering level for each device on the network through the network map page on the genie app To set up parental controls 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Parental Controls The Parental Controls website opens Click the button for the app or version that you want to download and use Follow the onscreen instructions to download and install the genie app Open the genie app and select Parental Controls After installation Live Parental Controls automatically starts Live Parental Controls Powered by OpenDNS NETGEAR D
256. ord The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Block Services Block Services Services Blocking Never Per Schedule Always Service Table Service Type Port IP If this is the first time that you add an outbound firewall rule in the Services Blocking section specify how the modem router applies outbound rules e Per Schedule Use keyword blocking according to a schedule that you set For more information see Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules on page 134 Always Use keyword blocking continuously Control Access to the Internet 131 10 11 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Below the Service Table click the Add button Service Type User Defined v Protocol TCP Starting Port 1 65535 Ending Port 1 65535 Service Type User Defined Filter Services For Only This IP Address 192 16 1 IP Address Range 192 168 1 AJl IP Addresses From the Service Type menu select User Defined Specify a new outbound rule as described in the following table ed S eee eee Protocol Select the protocol TCP or UDP that is associated with the service or application If you are unsure select TCP UDP Starting Port Enter the start port for the service or application Ending Port If the service or application uses a
257. ord Block sites containing these keywords or domain names Delete Keyword Clear List Allow trusted IP address to visit blocked sites Trusted IP Address 192 168 1 Specify a keyword blocking option e Per Schedule Use keyword blocking according to a schedule that you set For more information see Set Up a Schedule for Keyword Blocking and Outbound Firewall Rules on page 134 Always Use keyword blocking continuously Control Access to the Internet 125 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In the Type keyword or domain name here field enter a keyword or domain Here are some sample entries e Specify XXX to block http Awww badstuff com xxx html e Specify com if you want to allow only sites with domain suffixes such as edu or gov e Enter a period to block all Internet browsing access Click the Add Keyword button The keyword or domain is added to the Block sites containing these keywords or domain names field which is also referred to as the blocked list To add more keywords or domains repeat Step 6 and Step 7 The keyword list supports up to 32 entries Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Remove a Keyword or Domain From the Blocked List If you no longer need a keyword or domain on the blocked list you can remove the keyword or domain To remove a keyword or domain from the blocked list 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or
258. oritizes WiFi data packets from different applications based on four access categories voice video best effort and background For an application to receive the benefits of WMM QoS WMM must be enabled on both the application and the client running that application Legacy applications that do not support WMM and applications that do not require QoS are assigned to the best effort category which receives a lower priority than voice and video WMM QoS is automatically enabled for the modem router In some circumstances you might want to disable WMM To manage WMM QoS 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt QoS Setup The QoS Setup page displays Click the WMM tab The Quality of Service page displays Disable or enable WMM QoS by doing the following e To disable WMM QoS for the 2 4 GHz radio clear the Enable WMM Wi Fi multimedia settings 2 4GHz b g n check box To enable WMM QoS for the 2 4 GHz radio select the Enable WMM Wi Fi multimedia settings 2 4GHz b g n check box By default WMM QoS is enabled for the 2 4 GHz radio e To disable WMM QoS for the 5 GHz radio clear the Enable WMM
259. ork Remove from the list a Edit iE Device Name MAC Address Connection Type A ANDROID C0 D1 D1 80 F0 D1 Wireless A table displays the detected device name MAC address and connection type of the devices that are not connected and are blocked from accessing the network To add a device to the blocked list do the following a Click the Add button The Add Blocked Device page displays S Enter the MAC address and device name for the device that you want to block 9 On the Add Blocked Device page click the Apply button The device is added to the blocked list on the Access Control page To remove a device from blocked list do the following a Select the check box for the device b Click the Delete button Control Access to the Internet 122 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The device is removed from the blocked list 8 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Add Devices to or Remove Them From the Allowed List If you set up an access list that blocks all new devices from accessing your network you must specify which devices are allowed to access your network To add or remove devices that are allowed 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The use
260. ort PPP over ATM PPPoA Login Enter the login name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP This login name is often an email address Enter the password that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Service Name If Required Enter the service name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Often a service name is not required Connection Mode Select how the Internet connection functions Always On Once the Internet connection is established it remains active This is the default setting Dial on Demand When someone attempts to connect to the Internet the Internet connection is established When the idle time out period expires the Internet connection is terminated Manually Connect You must connect to the Internet manually see View Establish or Terminate the PPPoE or PPPoA Internet Connection on page 232 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 66 11 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ee beea S Idle Timeout In Minutes Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Use Static IP Address If you select Dial on Demand from the Connection Mode menu enter the idle time out period in minutes The idle time out specifies how long the modem router keeps the Internet connection active when no one on the network is using the Internet connection The default is 5 minutes To
261. ot need to power cycle the modem or the DSL cable is already fully inserted in the correct ports do the following a Select the None of the above radio button b Click the Next button 19 Only if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the IP address for the Internet connection The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection IP address If this page does not display continue with Step 20 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection IP Address Did your Internet Service Provider ISP assign to you a fixed static IP address This is a very rare specia deployment Select an option and click Next to proceed Yes My ISP assigned a fixed static IP address to me No did not get a fixed static IP address from my ISP don t know Take one of the following actions e lf your ISP assigned you a fixed static IP address do the following Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 30 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Select the Yes radio button b Click the Next button Enter the fixed IP settings assigned by your Internet Service Provider and click Next to proceed My IP Address Subnet Mask Default Gateway Preferred ONS Server Alternate DNS Server c Enter the address information that your ISP gave you for your fixed IP address configuration d Click the Next but
262. our Mac with a wired or WiFi connection to your router Set Up a Storage Device on a Mac We recommend that you use a new USB HDD or eSATA storage device or format your old USB HDD or eSATA storage device to do the Time Machine backup for the first time Use a blank partition to prevent some issues during backup using Time Machine The modem router supports GUID or MBR partitions To format your device and specify partitions Mis 2 Connect a USB or eSATA storage device to your Mac If your USB device uses a power supply connect it You must use the power supply when you connect the USB device to the Mac On your Mac go to Spotlight or the magnifying glass at the top right of the page and search for Disk Utility Open the Disk Utility select your USB HDD or eSATA storage device click the Erase tab and click the Erase button Click the Partition tab In the Partition Layout menu set the number of partitions that you want to use Click the Options button The Partition schemes display Select the GUID Partition Table or Master Boot Record radio button In the Format menu select Mac OS Extended Journaled Share a Storage Device 152 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 10 Click the OK button 11 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Prepare to Back Up a Large Amount of Data Before you back up a large amount of data with Time Machine we recommend that you follo
263. ovide detailed routing information to your modem router Typically you do not need to add static routes You must configure static routes only for unusual cases such as when you use multiple routers or multiple IP subnets on your network As an example of when a static route is needed consider the following case e Your primary Internet access is through an ADSL modem to an ISP e You use an ISDN router on your home network for connecting to the company where you are employed This router s address on your LAN is 192 168 1 100 e Your company s network address is 134 177 0 0 When you first configured your modem router two implicit static routes were created A default route was created with your ISP as the gateway and a second static route was created to your local network for all 192 168 1 x addresses With this configuration if you attempt to access a device on the 134 177 0 0 network your modem router forwards your request to the ISP The ISP forwards your request to the company where you are employed and the request is likely to be denied by the company s firewall In this case you must define a static route instructing your modem router that 134 177 0 0 is accessed through the ISDN modem router at 192 168 1 100 Here is an example e Through the destination IP address and IP subnet mask specify that this static route applies to all 134 177 x x addresses e Through the gateway IP address specify that all traffic for these ad
264. ower cycle the modem or the DSL or Ethernet cable is already fully inserted in the correct ports do the following a Select the None of the above radio button b Click the Next button 11 Only if the following page displays Specify how to manage problems with the detection of the IP address for the Internet connection The page that might display states that a problem occurred while the wizard was detecting the Internet connection IP address If this page does not display continue with Step 12 Problem Detecting the Internet Connection IP Address Did your Internet Service Provider ISP assign to you a fixed static IP address This is a very rare special deployment Select an option and click Next to proceed Yes My ISP assigned a fixed static IP address to me No I did not get a fixed static IP address from my ISP don t know Take one of the following actions lf your ISP assigned you a fixed static IP address do the following Manage the Internet Settings Manually 48 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select the Yes radio button Click the Next button Enter the fixed IP settings assigned by your Internet Service Provider and click Next to proceed My IP Address Subnet Mask Default Gateway Preferred ONS Server Alternate DNS Server Enter the address information that your ISP gave you for your fixed IP address configuration Click the Next button e lf your ISP did
265. ows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s LAN interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available If your ISP gave you a specific user class in the DHCP User Class If Required field enter the user class If your ISP did not give you a specific user class leave this field blank To specify a domain name in the DHCP Domain Name If Required field enter a domain name If your ISP gave you a specific domain name enter it in this field For example Earthlink Cable might require a host name of home and Comcast sometimes supplies a domain name If your ISP did not give you a specific domain name you can either leave this field blank or enter the domain name of your IPv6 ISP Do not enter the domain name for the IPv4 ISP here For example if your ISP s mail server is mail xxx yyy zzz enter xxx yyy zzz as the domain name Select an IP Address Assignment radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPVv 6 client function e Auto Config This is the default setting To specify the interface ID for the IPv6 address of the modem router s LAN interface select the Use This Inter
266. password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select Quality of Service The QoS Setup page displays If you are using Dynamic QoS the Dynamic QoS check box is selected Click the Update Now button The modem router checks for the newest version of the database and downloads it Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Participate in Dynamic QoS Analytics NETGEAR uses a QoS database of the most popular applications and services to implement Dynamic QoS As new applications and services become popular NETGEAR updates this database and automatically updates your modem router if you enabled Dynamic QoS You can opt in to share aggregate QoS information to help improve the Dynamic QoS feature To opt in to participate in Dynamic QoS analytics We 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive Optimize Performance 143 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Quality of Service QoS Setup lt lt acm Dynamic QoS Automatic traffic prioritization by application and device QoS does not increase your total Internet bandwidth or WiFi throughput Internet Ba
267. pen or displays only part of a web page e Yahoo email e MSN portal e America Online s DSL service e You use VPN and experience severe performance problems e You used a program to optimize MTU for performance reasons and now you are experiencing connectivity or performance problems If you suspect an MTU problem a common solution is to change the MTU to 1400 If you are willing to experiment you can gradually reduce the MTU from the maximum value of 1500 until the problem goes away The following table describes common MTU sizes and applications Manage the Internet Settings Manually 93 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Table 3 Common MTU sizes OO or VPN and is the default value for NETGEAR modem routers adapters and switches Maximum size to use for pinging Larger packets are fragmented 1436 Used in PPTP environments or with VPN 1458 Used in PPPoA environments 1400 Maximum size for AOL DSL Change the MTU Size WARNING An incorrect MTU setting can cause Internet communication problems For example you might not be able to access certain websites frames within websites secure login pages or FTP or POP servers Change the MTU only if you are sure that it is necessary for your ISP connection To change the MTU size 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens
268. plays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Select the Port Triggering radio button The port triggering settings display Select the Disable Port Triggering check box If this check box is selected the modem router does not apply port triggering rules even if you specified them Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 279 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Application Example Port Triggering for Internet Relay Chat Some application servers such as FTP and IRC servers send replies to multiple port numbers Using port triggering you can tell the modem router to open more incoming ports when a particular outgoing port starts a session An example is Internet Relay Chat IRC Your computer connects to an IRC server at destination port 6667 The IRC server not only responds to your originating source port but also sends an identify message to your computer on port 113 Using port triggering you can tell the modem router When you initiate a session with destination port 6667 you must also allow incoming traffic on port 113 to reach the originating computer The following sequence shows the effects of this port triggering rule 1 2 You open an IRC client program to start a chat session on your computer Your IRC client composes a request mes
269. ply button Your settings are saved Manage Simple Outbound Firewall Rules for Services and Applications A firewall protects one network the trusted network such as your LAN from another the untrusted network such as the Internet while allowing communication between the two The modem router provides one default outbound firewall rule It allows all access to the Internet that is the WAN You can add simple rules to prevent access to specific services and applications on the Internet In addition you can specify if a rule applies to one user a range of users or all users on your LAN The modem router lists many default services and applications that you can use in outbound rules You can also add an outbound firewall rule for a custom service or application Control Access to the Internet 128 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 For information about blocking specific keywords URLs or sites see Use Keywords to Block Internet Sites on page 124 This type of blocking is another aspect of the outbound firewall For information about inbound firewall rules see Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering on page 267 Note Service blocking means the same thing as applying outbound firewall rules Add an Outbound Firewall Rule You can add an outbound firewall rule to prevent access to a specific service or application on the Internet To add an outbound firewall rule 1 2 5 Launch
270. port since reset or manual clear The time elapsed since this port acquired the link DSL Link In addition to the xDSL firmware version the page displays the ADSL link information that is described in this table Connection Speed The downstream and upstream connection speed rates in Mbps Line Attenuation The downstream and upstream line attenuation LATN in dB The LATN expresses the signal quality Noise Margin The downstream and upstream signal to noise ratio margin SNRM in dB The SNRM expresses the signal quality in relation to interference Poll Interval The interval at which the statistics are updated on this page Change the Traffic Statistics Polling Frequency You can change the polling frequency or stop traffic polling To change the traffic statistics polling frequency or stop polling 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays In the Internet Port pane click the Show Statistics button Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 230 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A pop up window displays 6 Change th
271. provide a steady IPv6 connection The modem router never terminates the connection If the connection is terminated for example when the modem is turned off the modem router attempts to reestablish the connection immediately after the PPPoE connection becomes available again Select an IP Address Assignment radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPv6 client function This is the default setting e Auto Config The modem router automatically configures its IPv6 address based on the IPv6 protocol To specify the interface ID for the IPv6 address of the modem router s LAN interface select the Use This Interface ID check box and enter the interface ID If you do not specify an ID here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address Select the IPv6 filtering mode e Secured In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Config If your Internet connection does not use PPPoE DHCP a fixed IP address or pass through but is IPv6 use the Auto Config connection type which lets the modem router autoconfigure its IPv6 conne
272. puter or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 277 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Select the Port Triggering radio button Port Forwarding Port Triggering Please select the service type Port Forwarding Port Triggering Disable Port Triggering Port Triggering Time out in minutes 20 Port Triggering Portmap Table Enable Service Name Service Type Inbound Connection Service User 1 V FTPS TCP 990 TCP UDP 989 990 any 2 y IRC SSL TCP 6697 TCP UDP 6697 6697 192 168 1 97 Add Service C Edit Service x Delete Service The previous figure shows two port triggering rules In the Port Triggering Portmap Table select the radio button next to the service or application name Click the Delete Service button The rule is removed from the Port Triggering Portmap Table Specify the Time Out for Port Triggering The time out period for port triggering controls how long the inbound ports stay open when the modem router detects no activity A time out period is required because the mo
273. r Connection With a Login and PPTP or L2TP SOVICO ea reser can tice dedue boars a E ciatamnataace 77 Specify an IPv6 Internet CONMECTION eee eeeecceeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeenaaeees 80 IPv6 Internet Connections and IPv6 AddreSSeS scceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteneeeees 80 Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Detect 0 ccccceeeseeeeeeeeteeeeeees 81 Set Up an IPv6 6to4 Tunnel CONNECTION cece eeeeeeeeee teen eee eeeeeeeeeettaaeeetees 83 Set Up an IPv6 Pass Through Connection cccccceeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeee 85 Set Up an IPv6 Fixed Connection sssssesssrsesesnerssrrrsssrrrnserrnnrerrnnnsserrn neet 85 Set Up an IPv6 DHCP Connection ecceeceeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaaeeeeeenaeeeeenes 87 Set Up an IPv6 PPPOE ConnG CuO sais inc ccavetissan seen ciasestvaccntioiesssetsntaieescortecents 89 Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Config ccccceeeeeseeeeeeeeneeeeeee 91 Manage thie MTU SIZ is ssstarsancieianraniciartnasanGithacarlatinieen iene 93 MTU CORCSINS ruses carisinsssccaanarimaniarnndbaanatt AEA aE 93 Change the MTU SiZ isicccscccscssccsaccessssssaecctateensscesetdccctsnensntaaaansacnnicenstenesatecne 94 Chapter 4 Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network 97 View or Change the Basic WiFi SettingS ceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeesaeeeeeees 97 Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiF
274. r again About two minutes after the power is first applied the Power LED lights solid white indicating that the startup procedure is complete and the modem router is ready If the Power LED remains solid amber and does not turn solid white a failure occurred or the modem router is malfunctioning If the Power LED does not turn solid white do the following 1 Turn the power off and back on and wait several minutes to see if the modem router recovers 2 Ifthe modem router does not recover press and hold the Reset button to return the modem router to its factory settings Troubleshooting 285 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If the error persists a hardware problem might exist For recovery instructions or help with a hardware problem contact technical support at netgear com support WiFi LED Is Off If the WiFi LED remains off check to see if both radios on the modem router are disabled see Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 By default both radios are enabled and the WiFi LED lights solid white You Cannot Log In to the Modem Router If you are unable to log in to the modem router from a computer on your local network and use the modem router web pages check the following e Ifyou are using an Ethernet connected computer check the Ethernet connection between the computer and the modem router e Make sure that the IP address of your computer is on the same subnet as the modem router If
275. r name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Security gt Access Conirol The Access Control page displays Control Access to the Internet 123 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Click the View list of allowed devices not currently connected to the network link Access Control cancel You can use Access Control to allow or block computers or electronic devices from accessing your network V Turn on Access Control Access Rule This is a general rule You can also allow or block individual devices Allow all new devices to connect Block all new devices from connecting Status Device Name IP Address MAC Address Connection Type Allowed BUSINESSLAPTOP 192 168 1 2 60 66 66 DA66 7C Wireless NETGEAR84 View list of allowed devices not currently connected to the network Remove from the list _ Edit E Device Name MAC Address Connection Type PAVILION D0 68 9A 68 6B 41 Wireless gt View list of blocked devices not currently connected to the network A table displays the detected device name MAC address and connection type of the devices that are not connected but allowed to access the network 6 To add a device to the allowed list do the following a Click the Add button The Add Allowed Device page displays g Enter the MAC address and device name for the device that you want to allow On the Add Allowed Device page click
276. r pass through but is IPv6 use the Auto Config connection type which lets the modem router autoconfigure its IPv6 connection see Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Config on page 91 When you enable IPv6 and select any connection type other than IPv6 pass through the modem router starts the stateful packet inspection SPI firewall function on the WAN interface The modem router creates connection records and checks every inbound IPv6 packet If the inbound packet is not destined to the modem router itself and the modem router does not expect to receive such a packet or the packet is not in the connection record the modem router blocks this packet This function works in two modes In secured mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only IPv6 addresses are denoted by eight groups of hexadecimal quartets that are separated by colons You can reduce any four digit group of zeros within an IPv6 address to a single zero or omit it The following errors invalidate an IPv6 address e More than eight groups of hexadecimal quartets e More than four hexadecimal characters in a quartet e More than two colons in a row Set Up an IPv6 Connection Through Auto Detect If you are not sure what type of IPv6 connection the modem router uses use the Auto Detect connection type which lets the modem router detect the IPv6 type that is in use To set up an IPv6 Internet connection thro
277. r settings are saved Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Manage the Internet Settings Manually 76 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPTP or L2TP Service If you want to manually configure the cable or fiber connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet To view or specify the settings for a cable or fiber Internet connection that requires a login and uses a PPTP or L2TP service 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays From the WAN Preference menu select Must use Ethernet WAN By default the menu selection is Must use DSL WAN Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts Note If you use a WiFi device to connect
278. r that is available on the Internet This is the default setting e Static IP Address Enter the static IPv4 not IPv6 address of the remote relay modem router Your IPv6 ISP usually provides this address 7 Select an IP Address Assignment radio button e Use DHCP Server The modem router assigns IPv6 addresses to the devices on your home network the LAN through a DHCP server This method passes more information to LAN devices but some IPv6 systems might not support the DHCPv 6 client function This is the default setting e Auto Config The modem router automatically configures its IPv6 address based on the IPv6 protocol 8 To specify the interface ID for the IPv6 address of the modem router s LAN interface select the Use This Interface ID check box and enter the interface ID If you do not specify an ID here the modem router generates one automatically from its MAC address 9 Select the IPv 6 filtering mode Secured In secured mode which is the default mode the modem router inspects both TCP and UDP packets e Open In open mode the modem router inspects UDP packets only 10 Click the Apply button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 84 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Your settings are saved Set Up an IPv6 Pass Through Connection In IPv6 pass through mode the modem router works as a Layer 2 Ethernet switch with two ports LAN and WAN Ethernet ports for IPv6 packets The
279. radio is operating Blinking white The modem router is sending or receiving WiFi traffic over the 2 4 GHz radio Off The 2 4 GHz WiFi radio is off Solid white The 5 GHz WiFi radio is operating Blinking white The modem router is sending or receiving WiFi traffic over the 5 GHz radio Off The 5 GHz WiFi radio is off Solid white A USB device is connected and is ready Blinking white Data is being transmitted to or from the USB device Off No USB device is connected or someone clicked the Safely Remove Hardware button and it is now safe to remove the attached USB device Hardware Overview of the Modem Router 14 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Solid white The modem router is connected to an eSATA device that is ready Blinking white An eSATA device is plugged into the modem router and is trying to connect Off No eSATA device is connected Ethernet ports 1 4 The LED color indicates the speed white for Gigabit Ethernet connections and amber for 100 Mbps or 10 Mbps Ethernet connections e Solid white or solid amber A powered on device is connected to the Ethernet port Blinking white or blinking amber Data is being transmitted over the port e Off No powered on device is connected to the Ethernet port WiFi On Off button with Pressing this button for two seconds turns the 2 4 GHz and 5 GHz WiFi radios on and off WiFi LED If this LED is lit the WiFi radios are on If this
280. rase of 8 to 63 characters To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA WPA2 Enterprise This type of security requires that your WiFi network can access a RADIUS server For information about configuring WPA WPA2 Enterprise see Configure WPA WPA2 Enterprise WiFi Security on page 104 Wireless Network 5GHz 802 11a n ac Enable SSID Broadcast By default the modem router broadcasts its SSID so that WiFi stations can detect the WiFi name SSID in their scanned network lists To turn off the SSID broadcast clear the Enable SSID Broadcast check box Turning off the SSID broadcast provides additional WiFi security but users must know the SSID to be able to join the WiFi network of the modem router Enable Video Network If you want to stream high definition video select this check box When this option is selected the modem router uses video reliability algorithms to reduce jitter and packet loss during video presentations If you do not stream videos leave this check box cleared Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 101 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a e l ee Name SSID The SSID is the WiFi network name If you did not change the SSID the default SSID displays The default SSID is also printed on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 Note We recommend that you do not change the default SSID If you must change the SSID enter
281. re version is stated in the top right under the Logout button Read the new firmware release notes to determine whether you must reconfigure the modem router after updating Manually Upload New Firmware and Update the Modem Router Downloading firmware and updating the modem router are two separate tasks that are combined in the following procedure t amp To download new firmware manually and update your modem router 1 2 Visit downloadcenter netgear com locate the support page for your product and download the new firmware Read the new firmware release notes to determine whether you must reconfigure the modem router after updating Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Firmware Update The Firmware Update page displays Locate and select the firmware file on your computer a Click the Browse button b Navigate to the firmware file The file ends in img An example of a firmware file name is D7800 v1 0 0 38 img c Select the firmware file Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 218 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Click the Upload button
282. rect or that the information you entered for the ISP connection is correct For more information see one of the following sections Troubleshooting 287 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 4 Check to see if your ISP is experiencing a problem it might not be that the modem router cannot connect to the Internet but rather that your ISP cannot provide an Internet connection Obtain an Internet IP Address If the modem router cannot access the Internet but the DSL Internet LED lights solid white see if the modem router can obtain an Internet IP address from the ISP Unless the modem router is assigned a static IP address the modem router requests an IP address from the ISP You can determine whether the request was successful using the modem router web pages To check the Internet IP address 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home The ADVANCED Home page displays 5 Inthe Internet Port
283. rick Concrete If you are using adjacent access points use different radio frequency channels to reduce interference Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 20 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Connect to the Modem Router During and after installation you can connect to the modem router s network through a wired or WiFi connection If you set up your computer to use a static IP address change the settings of your computer so that it uses Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol DHCP Connect to the Modem Router Through an Ethernet Cable You can connect your computer to the modem router using an Ethernet cable and join the modem router s local area network LAN To connect your computer to the modem router with an Ethernet cable 1 Make sure that the modem router is receiving power its Power LED is lit 2 Connect an Ethernet cable to an Ethernet port on your computer 3 Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to one of the numbered Ethernet ports Your computer connects to the local area network LAN A message might display on your computer screen to notify you that an Ethernet cable is connected Join the WiFi Network of the Modem Router Choose either the manual or the WPS method to add a WiFi device such as a computer iPhone iPad or gaming device to the WiFi network of the modem router Manual Method On the WiFi device that you want to connect to the modem router yo
284. roblems persist register your NETGEAR product and contact NETGEAR technical support When the modem router connects to the Internet you are prompted to download and install the free NETGEAR Desktop genie app and the free ReadySHARE Vault app Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber Service You can install your modem router for cable or fiber Ethernet WAN service or for DSL service If you use a cable or fiber modem follow the procedure that is described in this section If you use a DSL modem follow the procedure that is described in Cable the Modem Router for DSL Service and Access the Modem Router on page 24 The following figure shows the cabling of your modem router for cable or fiber service Figure 8 Modem router cabling for cable or fiber service To connect your modem router to a cable or fiber service 1 Unplug your cable or fiber modem s power leaving the modem connected to the wall jack for your Internet service If your cable or fiber modem includes a battery backup remove the battery 3 Use an Ethernet cable to connect the cable or fiber modem to the red Internet port on the modem router Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 32 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If your cable or fiber modem includes a battery backup reinsert the battery Plug in and turn on your cable or fiber modem Connect the power adapter to the modem router and plug it into an el
285. routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select Internet The Internet Setup page displays From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other From the Transfer Mode menu select VDSL PTM When you select VDSL PTM from the Transfer Mode menu the only option in the DSL Mode menu is VDSL2 Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected Note For some ISPs you can select the IPTV virtual interface from the menu above the Enable This Interface check box If you are specifying the settings for the IPTV virtual interface select IPTV from the menu However first specify the settings for the Internet virtual interface which is the default interface before you specify the settings for the IPTV virtual interface Scroll down to the Does your Internet connection require a login section and select the No radio button Manage the Internet Settings Manually 60 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The following figure shows the settings that display w
286. rrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet t To view or specify the settings for a cable or fiber Internet connection that does not require a login 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt WAN Setup The WAN Setup page displays 5 From the WAN Preference menu select Must use Ethernet WAN By default the menu selection is Must use DSL WAN 6 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts Manage the Internet Settings Manually 68 10 11 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Note If you use a WiFi device to connect to the modem router you might need to log in again Select BASIC gt Internet The Internet Setup page displays From the Select Country menu select the country in which you use the modem router The Select Country menu is not available in all countries and might be masked out From the Select Internet Service Provider menu select the Internet service provider ISP that you are using If your ISP is not in the menu select Other Make sure that the Enable This Interface check box is selected
287. rver Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays Clear the Use Router as DHCP Server check box Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Change the Modem Router s Device Name The modem router s device name is D7800 This device name displays in a file manager when you browse your network To change the modem router s device name 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 211 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 5 Click the upper Edit button The Device Name page displays In the Device Name field enter a new name Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Set Up and Manage Custom Static Routes Static routes pr
288. ry backup you might need to remove pletely start up yr th is not fully ins 1 make sure that the thernet cable is securely plugged in to the broadband modem port and the router Internet ycled the modem and waited for 2 minutes ith the DSL Ethemet cable None of the above Take one of the following actions e If you did not yet power cycle the modem do so now a Unplug your modem s power leaving the modem connected to the wall jack for your Internet service If your modem includes a battery backup remove the battery Wait 10 seconds If your modem includes a battery backup reinsert the battery Plug in your modem s power and turn on your modem oap Wait two minutes Select the I just power cycled the modem and waited for 2 minutes radio button Click the Next button 7 e See if the DSL or Ethernet cable is not fully inserted or is inserted at the wrong place If necessary do the following Manage the Internet Settings Manually 47 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Fully insert the DSL or Ethernet cable in the correct port on the modem and in the correct port on the modem router If you use a DSL cable it must be connected to the gray DSL port If you use an Ethernet cable it must be connected to the red Internet port b Select the I corrected a problem with the DSL Ethernet cable radio button c Click the Next button e lf you do not need to p
289. s destination IP address with your computer s IP address and forwards the message to your computer When you finish your chat session your modem router eventually senses a period of inactivity in the communications The modem router then removes the session information from its session table and incoming traffic is no longer accepted on port numbers 33333 or 113 Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 280 Troubleshooting 1 6 This chapter provides information to help you diagnose and solve problems you might experience with your modem router If you do not find the solution here check the NETGEAR support site at support netgear com for product and contact information This chapter contains the following sections Reboot the Modem Router From Its Web Page on page 282 e Quick Tips for Troubleshooting on page 282 e Troubleshoot With the LEDs on page 284 You Cannot Log In to the Modem Router on page 286 Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 e Changes Are Not Saved on page 290 e Troubleshoot the WiFi Connectivity on page 291 e Troubleshoot Your Network Using the Ping Utility on page 291 281 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Reboot the Modem Router From Its Web Page You or NETGEAR technical support can reboot the modem router from its web page either locally or remotely for example when the modem router seems to be unstable or is not operating normally To reboot t
290. s assigned by the ISP to the modem router Default Gateway The IP address of the default gateway of the ISP that the modem router communicates with DHCP Server The IP address of the DHCP server of the ISP that issues the IP address to the modem router Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 231 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ez ee DNS Server The IP address of the Domain Name System DNS server of the ISP that provides translation of network names to IP addresses Lease Expires The time at which the DHCP lease expires The type of DHCP connection determines whether this field displays onscreen Lease Obtained The time at which the modem router obtained the DHCP lease The type of DHCP connection determines whether this field displays onscreen 6 To renew the Internet connection when the connection is active click the Renew button 7 To terminate the Internet connection when the connection is active click the Release button 8 Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes View Establish or Terminate the PPPoE or PPPOA Internet Connection You can view information about a PPPoE or PPPoA Internet connection of the modem router and establish or terminate such a connection This information displays only if the modem router connects to the ISP network over a PPPoE or PPPoA connection A PPPoE connection can function over an ADSL VDSL cable or fiber connection A
291. sage to an IRC server using a destination port number of 6667 the standard port number for an IRC server process Your computer then sends this request message to your modem router Your modem router creates an entry in its internal session table describing this communication session between your computer and the IRC server Your modem router stores the original information performs Network Address Translation NAT on the source address and port and sends this request message through the Internet to the IRC server Noting your port triggering rule and observing the destination port number of 6667 your modem router creates another session entry to send any incoming port 113 traffic to your computer The IRC server sends a return message to your modem router using the NAT assigned source port for example port 33333 as the destination port and also sends an identify message to your modem router with destination port 113 When your modem router receives the incoming message to destination port 33333 it checks its session table to see if a session is active for port number 33333 Finding an active session the modem router restores the original address information replaced by NAT and sends this reply message to your computer When your modem router receives the incoming message to destination port 113 it checks its session table and finds an active session for port 113 associated with your computer The modem router replaces the message
292. seeeeeaauags 16 eSATA Porton the Right Paneli ssisrssriseriuccnninaenn n 16 Connect an eSATA DeviCe seeeseeeeseeeeirrneertrinirtiertnirrntttrinnntrieretirenneterenrnnne 17 Bottom Panel Product Label ccccceccceeececeeseeeeceeeeeeeseseeeeeeeeeeeaeseeeeeaaseeeaeaasees 17 Chapter 2 Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network Position Your Modem ROUIGM sisissiessealenestvadiniel yee romnthetveredeauiett eatandiaaeauaninbinant 20 Connect to the Modem Routel cccceesessseceeeeeeeseeeeneeeeeeeeseeeenneeeeeeeeeeesssssnaaees 21 Connect to the Modem Router Through an Ethernet Cable 0 cceeeee 21 Join the WiFi Network of the Modem Route ccccceeeeeesesseneeeeeeeeeeeeees 21 Mandal Meth d isaer tain nA aaiees 21 Wi Fi Protected Setup Method ccceeeccceeeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeeesaeeeeeesieeeeeeeees 22 Types f TOMS crine ener arraie Cia erT Te KE i EAT E DEEA ESEE 22 Automatic Internet SQtuipisssescsicsesetecatsyvastins ase dsnaceceonteeatexendeenienecenaneretentintents 23 Set Up Your Modem Router for DSL ServiCe cccccccsssssseeeeeeeeesssseeeeeeeeees 24 DSL SEVICE i eaiercaretas stead asses taiines tated retiree aca tea edenaidaeadd 24 Cable the Modem Router for DSL Service and Access the Modem Router 24 Set Up the Modem Router for Cable or Fiber ServiCe cccccccsesssessseeeeeeees 32 Log In to the Modem Router After Setup to View or Change Settings 38 Chang
293. serpton Destination IP Address Enter the IP address for the final destination of the route IP Subnet Mask Enter the IP subnet mask for the final destination of the route If the destination is a single host enter 255 255 255 255 Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 213 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Description Gateway IP Address Enter the IP address of the gateway The IP address of the gateway must be on the same LAN segment as the modem router Metric Enter a number from 1 through 15 This value represents the number of routers between your network and the destination Usually a setting of 2 or 3 works but if this is a direct connection set it to 1 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The static route is added to the table on the Static Routes page Change a Static Route You can change an existing static route To change a static route 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Static Routes The Static Routes page displays In the Static Routes table select the radio button to the left of the route Click the Edit butto
294. sical button or a software button You can use the physical button and software button to let a WiFi device join only the main WiFi network not the guest WiFi network To let a WiFi device join the modem router s main WiFi network using WPS with the push button method 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt WPS Wizard The page displays a description of the WPS method Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 108 5 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Click the Next button Select a setup method Push Button recommended You can either press the physical push button on the router or click the button soft push button in this screen A ay PIN Number By default the Push Button recommended radio button is selected Either click the button onscreen or press the WPS button on the right side panel of the modem router For two minutes the modem router attempts to find the WiFi device that is the client that you want to join the modem router s main WiFi network During this time the WiFi LED on the top panel of the modem router blinks white Within two minutes
295. sponds with an echo reply You can easily troubleshoot a network using the ping utility in your computer or workstation Test the LAN Path to Your Modem Router You can ping the modem router from your computer to verify that the LAN path to your modem router is set up correctly To ping the modem router from a Windows computer 1 2 From the Windows taskbar click the Start button and select Run In the field provided enter ping followed by the IP address of the modem router as in this example Troubleshooting 291 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ping 192 168 1 1 Click the OK button A message such as the following one displays Pinging lt IP address gt with 32 bytes of data If the path is working you see this message Reply from lt IP address gt bytes 32 time NN ms TTL xxx If the path is not working you see this message Request timed out If the path is not functioning correctly one of the following problems might be occurring Wrong physical connections For a wired connection make sure that the numbered LAN port LED is lit for the port to which you are connected Check that the appropriate LEDs are on for your network devices If your modem router and computer are connected to a separate Ethernet switch make sure that the link LEDs are lit for the switch ports that are connected to your computer and modem router Wrong network configuration Verify that the Ethernet card
296. ssword is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 250 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Wireless Settings Advanced Wireless Settings Advanced Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n V Enable Wireless Router Radio V Enable 20 40 MHz Coexistence CTS RTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic v Transmit Power Control 100 v Turn off wireless signal by schedule The wireless signal is scheduled to turn off during the following time period Period stt en RecurrencePatem Add a new period Edit Delete Advanced Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac V Enable Wireless Router Radio CTSIRTS Threshold 1 2347 2347 Preamble Mode Automatic z Transmit Power Control 100 v Turn off wireless signal by schedule The wireless signal is scheduled to turn off during the following time period Perioa Start ena Recurrence patem Add a new period Edit Delete 5 Enter the settings as described in the following table With the exception of Enable 20 40 MHz Coexistence the descriptions in the table not the settings onscreen apply to both the Advanced Wireless Settings 2 4GHz b g n section and the Advanced Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 1 1a n ac section Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 251 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 Wi
297. st name as the account name For more information see one of the following sections e Specify an ADSL Connection Without a Login on page 50 e Specify a VDSL Connection Without a Login on page 59 e Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection Without a Login on page 68 Your ISP might be rejecting the Ethernet MAC addresses of all but one of your computers Many broadband ISPs restrict access by allowing traffic only from the MAC address of your modem but some additionally restrict access to the MAC address of a single computer connected to that modem In this case configure your modem router to clone or spoof the MAC address from the authorized computer For more information see one of the following sections e Manually Set Up an ADSL Internet Connection on page 50 e Manually Set Up a VDSL Internet Connection on page 59 e Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection on page 68 Troubleshooting 293 Supplemental Information This appendix covers the following topics Factory Settings on page 295 Technical Specifications on page 297 17 294 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Factory Settings You can reset the modem router to the factory default settings that are shown in the following table For more information about resetting the modem router to its factory settings see Return the Modem Router to Its Factory Default Settings on page 221 Table 5 D7800 modem router factory default settings
298. sword The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Firmware Update The Firmware Update page displays Click the Check button The modem router detects new firmware if any is available and displays a message asking if you want to download and install it To download and install the new firmware click the Yes button The modem router locates the firmware downloads it and begins the update WARNING To avoid the risk of corrupting the firmware do not interrupt the update For example do not close the browser click a link or load a new page Do not turn off the modem router Wait until the modem router finishes restarting and the Power LED turns solid white A progress bar shows the progress of the firmware upload process The firmware upload process takes several minutes When the upload is complete your modem router restarts Verify that the modem router runs the new firmware version Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 217 8 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network b Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens c Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays The firmwa
299. sword is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt ReadySHARE gt Advanced Settings USB Storage Advanced Settings Network Device Name o0 Ci Workgroup Workgroup Enable Access Method Link Port V Network Neighborhood MacShare 107800 v HTTP http readysharerouterlogin netshares 80 F HTTP via internet https 192 168 100 168 shares 443 B FTP fip readyshare routerlogin net shares 21 A FTP via internet 1192 168 100 168 shar 21 Available Network Folders Share Name Read Access Write Access Folder Name Volume Name Total Space Free Space 5 WO7800 T_Drive All no password All no password U STORENGO 3 71GB 616 MB 5 WD7800 USB_Storage All no password All no password TA STORENGO 3 71GB 1 11 GB Note To set up or modify your ReadyCLOUD user account visit http readycloud netgearcom Safely Remove USB Device The previous figure shows two USB devices attached to the modem router 5 Select the FTP via internet check box 6 Click the Apply button Manage Dynamic DNS and Access Storage Devices Through the Internet 173 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Your settings are saved 7 To limit access to the admin user do the following a Inthe Available Network Folders list select a device If only one device is connected it is automatically selected b Click the Edit button USB Device U STORE N GO UA Brows
300. t Manage Port Triggering for Services and Applications Port triggering is a dynamic extension of port forwarding that is useful in these cases e An application must use port forwarding to more than one local computer but not simultaneously e An application must open incoming ports that are different from the outgoing port With port triggering the modem router monitors traffic to the Internet from an outbound trigger port that you specify For outbound traffic from that port the modem router saves the IP address of the computer that sent the traffic The Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 273 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 modem router temporarily opens the incoming port or ports that you specify in your rule and forwards that incoming traffic to that destination Port forwarding creates a static mapping of a port number or range of ports to a single local computer Port triggering can dynamically open ports to any computer when needed and close the ports when they are no longer needed Note If you use applications such as multiplayer gaming peer to peer connections real time communications such as instant messaging or remote assistance enable Universal Plug and Play UPnP See Improve Network Connections With Universal Plug and Play on page 146 Add a Port Triggering Rule The modem router does not provide default services and applications for port triggering rules You must def
301. t 6 feet 1 8 meters away and see if the signal strength improves Make sure that the WiFi signal is not blocked by objects between the modem router and your WiFi device Make sure that the WiFi LED on the modem router is not off If this LED is off both WiFi radios might be disabled For more information about the WiFi radios see Control the WiFi Radios on page 115 Make sure that the modem router s SSID broadcast is not disabled If the modem router s SSID broadcast is disabled the WiFi network name is hidden and does not display in your WiFi device s scanning list To connect to a hidden network you must enter the network name and the WiFi password For more information about the SSID broadcast see Manage the Basic WiFi Settings and WiFi Security of the Main Network on page 97 Make sure that your WiFi device does not use a static IP address but is configured to receive an IP address automatically with DHCP For most devices DHCP is the default setting 1 One second after the power is first applied the Power LED lights solid amber for about 10 seconds turns off for about 2 seconds and then lights solid amber again 2 About two minutes after the power is first applied the Power LED lights solid white indicating that the startup procedure is complete and the modem router is ready Verify the following The DSL Internet LED amp is solid white The 2 4 GHz WiFi LED and 5 GHz WiFi LED are blinkin
302. t to change the WiFi settings of the modem router s main network use a wired connection to avoid being disconnected when the new WiFi settings take effect To configure WEP security 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Wireless The Wireless Settings page displays 5 From the Mode menu select Up to 54 Mbps The page adjusts to display the WEP radio button Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 106 6 10 11 12 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 In the Security Options section select the WEP radio button Security Options None WEP WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA WPA2 Enterprise Security Encryption WEP Authentication Type Automatic v Encryption Strength 64 bit v Security Encryption WEP Key Key1 Key 2 Key 3 Key 4 From the Authentication Type menu select one of the following types e Automatic Clients can use either Open System or Shared Key authentication e Shared Key Clients can use only Shared Key authentication From the Encryption Strength menu select the encryption key size e 64 bit Standard WEP encryption using 40
303. ter and verify the DNS address Alternatively you can configure your computer manually with DNS addresses as explained in your operating system documentation The modem router might not be configured as the TCP IP router on your computer For information about TCP IP problems see Troubleshoot Your Network Using the Ping Utility on page 291 If your computer obtains its information from the modem router by DHCP reboot the computer and verify the modem router address Changes Are Not Saved If the modem router does not save the changes that you make in a modem router web page do the following When entering configuration settings always click the Apply button before moving to another page or tab or your changes are lost Click the Refresh or Reload button in the web browser It is possible that the changes occurred but that the old settings remain in the web browser s cache Troubleshooting 290 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Troubleshoot the WiFi Connectivity If you are experiencing trouble connecting over WiFi to the modem router try to isolate the problem Make sure that the WiFi settings in your WiFi device and modem router match exactly For a device that is connected over WiFi the WiFi network name SSID and WiFi security settings of the modem router and WiFi computer must match exactly The default SSID and password are on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17
304. thawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Se e ee From the Mode menu select one of the following modes e Up to 54 Mbps Legacy mode This mode allows 802 11n 802 11g and 802 11b devices to join the network but limits 802 11n devices to functioning at up to 54 Mbps Up to 289 Mbps Neighbor friendly mode for reduced interference with neighboring WiFi networks This mode allows 802 11n 802 119 and 802 1 1b devices to join the network but limits 802 11n devices to functioning at up to 289 Mbps Up to 800 Mbps Performance mode This mode allows 802 11n 802 119 and 802 11b devices to join the network and allows 802 11n devices to function at up to 600 Mbps This mode is the default mode Note The 800 Mbps performance mode requires 256 QAM support on the WiFi client Note WPA PSK security supports speeds of up to 54 Mbps Even if your devices are capable of a higher speed WPA PSK security limits their speed to 54 Mbps Security Options This information applies to the 2 4 GHz WiFi network Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 100 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 ea e Note We recommend that you do not change your preset security settings WPA2 PSK AES If you must change the WiFi security select one of the following WiFi security options for the modem router s WiFi network None An open WiFi network that does not provide any security Any WiFi device can join
305. the TCP radio button To change the port scroll down to the Service Port field and type the port number that you want to use Use VPN to Access Your Network 258 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Note For information about configuring the type of access see Use VPN to Access Your Internet Service at Home on page 264 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved VPN is enabled in the modem router but you must install and set up OpenVPN software on your computer before you can use a VPN connection see Install OpenVPN Software on a Windows Computer on page 259 and nstall OpenVPN Software on a Mac Computer on page 261 Install OpenVPN Software on a Windows Computer You must install OpenVPN software on each computer that you plan to use for VPN connections to your modem router To install VPN client software on a Windows computer 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VPN Service The VPN Service page displays Make sure that the Enable VPN Service check box is selected For more information see Specify VPN Service in the Modem Router on page 258 Click th
306. the local area connection with the device name TAP Windows Adapter c Select the local area connection and change its name not its device name to NETGEAR VPN If you do not change the VPN interface name the VPN tunnel connection will fail For more information about using OpenVPN on a Windows computer visit openvpn net index php open source documentation howto html quick Install OpenVPN Software on a Mac Computer You must install Open VPN software on each computer that you plan to use for VPN connections to your modem router To install VPN client software on a Mac computer 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Use VPN to Access Your Network 261 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VPN Service The VPN Service page displays 5 Make sure that the Enable VPN Service check box is selected For more information see Specify VPN Service in the Modem Router on page 258 6 Click the For non Windows button to download the OpenVPN configuration files Step 9 provides information about what to do with the downloaded OpenVPN configuration files To downlo
307. the network We recommend that you do not use an open WiFi network WEP Wired Equivalent Privacy WEP security is a legacy authentication and data encryption mode that is superseded by WPA PSK and WPA2 PSK The WEP option displays only if you select Up to 54 Mbps from the Mode menu For information about configuring WEP see Configure WEP Legacy WiFi Security on page 106 WPA2 PSK AES This option is the default setting This type of security enables WiFi devices that support WPA2 to join the modem router s 2 4 GHz WiFi network If you did not change the passphrase the default passphrase displays The default passphrase is printed on the product label see Bottom Panel Product Label on page 17 WPA2 provides a secure connection but some older WiFi devices do not detect WPA2 and support only WPA If your network includes such older devices select WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES security We recommend that you do not change the default passphrase If you must change the passphrase in the Passphrase field enter a phrase of 8 to 63 characters To join the modem router s WiFi network a user must enter this passphrase WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES This type of security enables WiFi devices that support either WPA or WPA2 to join the modem router s 2 4 GHz WiFi network However WPA PSK TKIP is less secure than WPA2 PSK AES and limits the speed of WiFi devices to 54 Mbps To use this type of security in the Passphrase field enter a ph
308. ting lets you connect and access all your storage devices 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 8 Click the Approved Devices button USB Drive Approved Devices Apply gt E Allow only approved devices Approved USB Devices Volume Name Device Name Capacity STORE NGO Verbatim STORE N GO 3 72 GB Available USB Devices Volume Name Device Name Capacity STORE NGO Verbatim STORE N GO 3 72 GB STORE N GO Verbatim STORE N GO 3 72 GB Add 9 Inthe Available USB Devices table select the storage device that you want to approve 10 Click the Add button The storage device is added to the Approved USB Devices table 11 To approve a second storage device that is attached to the modem router repeat Step 9 and Step 10 12 Select the Allow only approved devices check box 13 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved To approve another USB device that is not connected to a USB port first remove a USB device from the USB port see Safely Remove a USB Device on page 165 connect the other USB device and repeat this procedure Share a Storage Device 164 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Safely Remove a USB Device Before you physically disconnect a USB device from the USB port on the modem router log in to the modem router and take the drive offline To remove a USB device safely 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2
309. tion The Control Center Configuration page displays From the Language menu select a language 4 Click the OK button The next time the NETGEAR USB Control Center starts the language changes Specify the Time Out To specify the time out 1 Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon Ei The main page displays 2 Select Tools gt Configuration The Control Center Configuration page displays 3 Inthe Timeout field type the number of minutes The time out is the number of minutes that a computer holds its connection to the printer when the connection is not being used 4 Click the OK button The Control Center Configuration page displays Share a USB Printer 190 Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 1 1 This chapter describes how you can manage the WAN and LAN network settings of the modem router The chapter includes the following sections e Change the Physical WAN Connection Preference on page 192 e Enable Bridge Mode for IPTV Devices on page 192 e Enable and Configure a VLAN on page 194 e Set Up a Bridge for a Port Group or VLAN Tag Group on page 197 Manage the WAN Security Settings on page 201 e Set Up a Default DMZ Server on page 202 e Manage IGMP Proxying on page 203 e Manage NAT Filtering on page 203 e Manage the SIP Application Level Gateway on page 204 e Manage the Modem Router s LAN IP Address Settings on page 205 e Manage the Router Information Protocol Settings on page 206 e M
310. tion is not terminated automatically My IP Address Enter the IP address that is assigned by your ISP to make the connection with the ISP server IP Subnet Mask Enter the IP subnet mask that is assigned by your ISP to make the connection with the ISP server Server Address Enter the IP address of the ISP server that your ISP gave you Gateway IP Address Enter the IP address of the ISP gateway that your ISP gave you If your ISP did not give you a gateway IP address leave this field blank Connection ID Name Enter the IP connection ID or name that your ISP gave you If your ISP did not give you a connection ID or name leave this field blank It is not common that you must enter a connection ID or name Note This field displays for PPTP service only Internet IP Address Get Dynamically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your IP address Your ISP automatically assigns these addresses Use Static IP Address Enter the IP address IP subnet mask and gateway IP address that your ISP assigned you for static IP address service The gateway is the ISP router to which your modem router connects Manage the Internet Settings Manually 79 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Se Obea Domain Name Server DNS Address The DNS server is used to look up site addresses based on their domain names Get Automatically from ISP Your ISP uses DHCP to assign your DNS servers Your ISP automatically assi
311. ton e lf your ISP did not assign you a fixed IP address or you do not know if your ISP assigned you a fixed IP address do the following a Select either the No or the I don t know radio button b Click the Next button Problem Detecting the Internet Connection MAC Address if you previously connected to your Internet service with a computer or another router NETGEAR Genie can use the same MAC address that worked before A MAC address is a unique number You can find the MAC address of the computer or router on its product label Enter the MAC address here format AABBCCODEEFF c Enter the MAC address of the computer or router with which you previously were able to connect to the Internet You might find the MAC address on the product label of your device Enter the MAC address in the AABBCCDDEEFF format not in the AA BB CC DD EE FF format d Click the Next button 20 If the Congratulations page still does not display and the modem router still does not connect to the Internet do the following a Review all your settings and make sure that you selected the correct options and entered everything correctly b Run the Setup Wizard one more time c Contact your ISP to verify that you are using the correct configuration information Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 31 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 d Read Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 e If p
312. tor the Traffic 224 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt ADVANCED Home Router Information Internet Port A0 63 91 7A 14 99 192 168 100 168 DHCP 255 255 255 0 192 168 100 1 So GS NETGEAR84 5G Europe 36 40 44 p 48 Up to 1733 Mbps On On v v Hardware Version 07800 MAC Address Firmware Version V1 0 0 38 IP Address GUI Language Version V1 0 0 245 Connection Operation Mode Router IP Subnet Mask LAN Port Domain Name Server MAC Address A0 63 91 7A 14 98 IP Address 192 168 1 1 DHCP Server On Name SSID NETGEARS4 Name SSID Region Europe Region Channel Auto 9 s 13 p Channel Mode Up to 800 Mbps Mode Wireless AP On Wireless AP Broadcast Name On Broadcast Name Wi Fi Protected Setup Configured Wi Fi Protected Setup h Guest Network 2 4GHz g Guest Network 5 0GHz Name SSID Wireless AP Broadcast Name NETGEAR Guest Name SSID on Wireless AP On Broadcast Name Allow guests to see each other and oft access my local network Configured NETGEAR 5G Guest Off On Allow guests to see each other and oft access my local network The information onscreen uses the following color coding A green flag Ka indicates that the cable connection or Internet connection is fine and no problems exist For a WiFi network the network is enabled and secured A red X E indicates that configuration problems exist
313. ts to the Internet you are prompted to download and install the free NETGEAR Desktop genie app and the free ReadySHARE Vault app Log In to the Modem Router After Setup to View or Change Settings After you set up the modem router for DSL cable or fiber service you can view or change the settings for the modem router To log in to the modem router 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 38 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Note You can also type http www routerlogin com or http 192 168 1 1 The procedures in this manual use http www routerlogin net The nature of the login window that opens depends on your web browser A username and password are being requested by http www routerlogin net The site says NETGEAR D7800 User Name Password eeeeesee Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive Click the OK button NETGEAR genie P outer r Nighthawk X4 D7800 V1 0 0 28 asic ABVANEESD Ca Internet gt Eg DA se Wireless 4 EA aS ec oe Attached Devices gt Auto X Internet Wireless Attached Devices Quality of Service gt SSID NETGEAR21 Number of devices 1 Parental Controls gt MEE Passwor
314. tures and uses the MAC address of the computer that you are now using You must use the one computer that is registered by the ISP Enter the MAC address that you want to use By default the field displays the MAC address of the Internet port 12 Click the Test button to test your Internet connection Manage the Internet Settings Manually 67 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Manually Set Up a Cable or Fiber Internet Connection You can view or change the modem router s cable or fiber Internet connection settings manually The following sections describe the options that are available to you to manually set up the cable or fiber Internet connection e Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection Without a Login on page 68 e Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service on page 72 e Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPTP or L2TP Service on page 77 Note Some ISPs require that you register on their website before you can obtain Internet service Follow the directions that your ISP gave you Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection Without a Login If you want to manually configure the cable or fiber connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering inco
315. ty for Windows computers e Download Mac installer and get started This is the utility for MAC computers Download the genie App and get started This is the utility for smartphones and tablets 4 Follow the onscreen instructions to download the ReadySHARE Printer utility setup file Install the ReadySHARE Printer Utility You must install the ReadySHARE Printer utility on each computer that will share the printer After you install it the utility displays as NETGEAR USB Control Center on your computer Share a USB Printer 183 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To install the utility 1 If necessary unzip the ReadySHARE Printer utility setup file 2 Double click the ReadySHARE Printer utility setup file that you downloaded Welcome to the InstallShield Wizard for NETGEAR USB Control Center The InstallShield R Wizard will install NETGEAR USB Control Center on your computer To continue click Next WARNING This program is protected by copyright law and international treaties 3 Follow the wizard instructions to install NETGEAR USB Control Center Share a USB Printer 184 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 After the InstallShield Wizard completes the installation the NETGEAR USB Control Center prompts you to select a language NETGEAR USB Control Center 4 Select a language from the menu and click the OK button Some firewall software suc
316. u can use the software application that manages your WiFi connections To connect a device manually to the WiFi network of the modem router 1 Make sure that the modem router is receiving power its Power LED is lit 2 Onthe WiFi device that you want to connect to your modem router open the software application that manages your WiFi connections This software scans for all WiFi networks in your area 3 Look for the modem router s network and select it Install and Access the Modem Router and Its Network 21 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you did not change the name of the network during the setup process look for the default WiFi network name SSID and select it The default SSID is on the product label NETGEAR Nighthawk X4S ox ams WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router WiFi Network Name SSID PTC XXX XX XXX ee Enter the modem router WiFi password The default WiFi password also referred to as the network key or passphrase is also on the product label Click the Connect button The device connects to the WiFi network of the modem router Wi Fi Protected Setup Method Wi Fi Protected Setup WPS is a standard for easily adding computers and other devices to a home network while maintaining security To use WPS Push N Connect make sure that all WiFi devices to be connected to the network are Wi Fi certified and support WPS During the connection process the client gets th
317. ugh auto detection 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Manage the Internet Settings Manually 81 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt IPv6 The IPv6 page displays 5 From the Internet Connection Type menu select Auto Detect ND CHRD GRECIAN Internet Connection Type Auto Detect v Connection Type DHCP Auto Config Router s IPv6 Address On WAN Not Available LAN Setup Router s IPv6 Address On LAN Not Available IP Address Assignment Use DHCP Server Auto Config Use This Interface ID 0 0 0 0 IPv6 Filtering Secured Open The modem router automatically detects the information in the following fields e Connection Type This field indicates the connection type that is detected e Router s IPv6 Address On WAN This field shows the IPv6 address that is acquired for the modem router s WAN or Internet interface The number after the slash is the length of the prefix which is also indicated by the underline _ under the IPv6 address If no address is acquired the field displays Not Available e Router s IPv6 Address On LAN This field
318. up window opens The fields that display depend on the type of Internet connection se IP Address The IP address that is assigned by the ISP to the modem router Subnet Mask The subnet mask that is assigned by the ISP to the modem router To establish the Internet connection when the connection is down click the Connect button To terminate the Internet connection when the connection is active click the Disconnect button Click the Close Window button The pop up window closes View Devices Currently on the Network You can view the active wired and WiFi devices in both the network to which the modem router is connected and the modem router network If you do not recognize a WiFi device it might be an intruder To display the wired and WiFi devices and change the device name device type or both 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select Attached Devices The Attached Devices page displays Wired devices are connected to the modem router with Ethernet cables WiFi devices are connected to the modem router through the WiFi network in either the 2 4 GHz band or the 5 GHz band 5 To display the MAC address type of device a
319. ur ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a VCI string leave this field blank Client Identifier String option 61 Enter the client identifier client ID string as indicated by your ISP If your ISP did not provide you with a client ID string leave this field blank 13 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 14 Click the Test button to test your Internet connection If the NETGEAR website does not display within one minute see Troubleshoot the Internet Connection on page 286 Specify a Cable or Fiber Connection With a Login and PPPoE Service If you want to manually configure the cable or fiber connection settings use the information that your ISP gave you to connect to your Internet service If you cannot find this information contact your ISP Entering incorrect information might prevent the modem router from connecting to the Internet Manage the Internet Settings Manually 72 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To view or specify the settings for a cable or fiber Internet connection that requires a login and uses a PPPoE service 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network 2 Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens 3 Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays 4 Select
320. ur application to print your document To release the printer so that all computers on the network can use it click the Disconnect button Print and Release the Printer t To print and release the printer to any computer on the network 1 To print your document use the print feature in your application The NETGEAR USB Control Center automatically connects your computer to the USB printer and prints the document If another computer is already connected to the printer your print job goes into a queue to wait to be printed If your document does not print use the NETGEAR USB Control Center to check the status See View or Change the Status of a Printer on page 187 Share a USB Printer 186 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 View or Change the Status of a Printer To view or change the status 1 Click the NETGEAR USB Control Center icon ea it NETGEAR USB Control Center System Tools About Device Status The Status column shows the status for each device e Available No print jobs are in progress You can use the USB printer from any computer in the network e Connected Your computer is connected to the printer and will be released when your print job is done e Manually Connected by Only the connected computer can use the printer e Waiting to Connect Your computer is not connected to the shared printer yet To print from your computer when the status shows
321. urrent Date Time Monday 22 Jun 2015 10 20 AM Traffic Volume Left No limit eid Connection Time Traffic Volume Mbytes hh mm Upload Avg Download Avg Total Avg Today 0 77 7 43 8 19 Yesterday 0 00 0 00 0 00 This week 0 77 0 11 7 43 1 06 8 19 1 17 This month 0 77 0 03 7 43 0 25 8 19 0 27 Last month 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 The Internet Traffic Statistics section displays when the traffic counter was started and what the traffic balance is The table displays information about the connection time and traffic volume in MB 6 To refresh the information onscreen click the Refresh button The information is updated 7 To display more information about the data traffic and to change the polling interval click the Traffic Status button The Traffic Status pop up window displays Restrict Internet Traffic by Volume You can record and restrict the traffic by volume in MB This is useful when your ISP measures your traffic in volume Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 239 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To record and restrict the Internet traffic by volume 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are
322. used between the modem router and the RADIUS server during authentication of a WiFi user 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved 8 Make sure that you can reconnect over WiFi to the network with its new security settings Manage the Basic WiFi Network Settings 105 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If you cannot connect over WiFi check the following e If your computer or WiFi device is already connected to another WiFi network in your area disconnect it from that WiFi network and connect it to the WiFi network that the modem router provides Some WiFi devices automatically connect to the first open network without WiFi security that they discover e If your computer or WiFi device is trying to connect to your network with its old settings before you changed the settings update the WiFi network selection in your computer or WiFi device to match the current settings for your network e Does your WiFi device display as an attached device See View Devices Currently on the Network on page 234 If it does it is connected to the network e Are you using the correct network name SSID and password Configure WEP Legacy WiFi Security Wired Equivalent Privacy WEP security is a legacy authentication and data encryption mode that is superseded by WPA PSK and WPA2 PSK WEP limits the WiFi transmission speed to 54 Mbps the modem router is capable of speeds of up 800 Mbps Tip If you wan
323. user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering The Port Forwarding Port Triggering page displays Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 276 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 Select the Port Triggering radio button Port Forwarding Port Triggering CCO GLEE Please select the service type Port Forwarding Port Triggering E Disable Port Triggering Port Triggering Time out in minutes 20 Port Triggering Portmap Table Enable Service Name Service Type Inbound Connection Service User 1 v FTPS TCP 990 TCP UDP 989 990 any 2 m IRC SSL TCP 6697 TCP UDP 6697 6697 192 168 1 97 Add Service Edit Service x Delete Service The previous figure shows two port triggering rules In the Port Triggering Portmap Table select the radio button next to the service or application name Click the Edit Service button The Port Triggering Services page displays Change the settings For information about the settings see Add a Port Triggering Rule on page 274 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The changed rule displays in the Port Triggering Portmap Table on the Port Forwarding Port Triggering page Remove a Port Triggering Rule You can remove a port triggering rule that you no longer need To remove a port triggering rule 1 2 Launch a web browser from a com
324. uter user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Backup Settings Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 219 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 The Backup Settings page displays Click the Back Up button Choose a location to store the file on your computer The name of the backup file is NETGEAR_D7800 cfg Follow the directions of your browser to save the file Restore the Settings If you backed up the configuration file you can restore the configuration from this file To restore configuration settings that you backed up 1 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Administration gt Backup Settings The Backup Settings page displays Click the Browse button and navigate to and select the saved configuration file The name of the backup file from which you can restore the configuration is NETGEAR_D7800 cfg Click the Restore button The configuration is uploaded to the modem router When the restoration
325. utton The page adjusts to display the AP Mode details We recommend that when you use AP mode you let the modem router get its IP address dynamically from your existing router However if you are sure that must use a static IP address you can specify a static IP address from your existing router s LAN IP address pool To specify static IP address for the modem router do the following a Select the Use fixed IP Address not recommended radio button A pop up window opens b Enter all static IP addresses 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved The modem router restarts 8 To reconnect close your browser relaunch it and log in to the modem router by entering http www routerlogin net Set Up a WiFi Bridge You can use the modem router as a WiFi bridge and connect multiple devices with WiFi at the faster 802 11ac speed To do this you need a WiFi router or access point AP in addition to the modem router One device is connected to the Internet modem and the other one functions as a WiFi bridge You can connect the modem router to the Internet modem and use the router or AP as a WiFi bridge assuming that the router or AP is capable of functioning as a WiFi bridge or the other way around connect the router or AP to the Internet modem and use the modem router as a WiFi bridge Of course you can also use two modem routers for such a setup Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 253 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VD
326. utton is selected From the Service Name menu select the service or application Manage Port Forwarding and Port Triggering 268 9 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 If the service or application that you want to add is not in the list create a port forwarding rule with a custom service or application see Add a Port Forwarding Rule With a Custom Service or Application on page 269 In the Server IP Address field enter the IP address of the computer that must provide the service or that runs the application 10 Click the Add button Your settings are saved and the rule is added to the table Add a Port Forwarding Rule With a Custom Service or Application The modem router lists default services and applications that you can use in port forwarding rules If the service or application is not predefined you can add a port forwarding rule with a custom service or application To add a port forwarding rule with a custom service or application 1 Find out which port number or range of numbers the service or application uses You can usually find this information by contacting the publisher of the service or application or through user groups or news groups Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default passwor
327. vanced Setup gt Wireless Settings The Advanced Wireless Settings page displays Scroll down to the bottom of the page WPS Settings Router s PIN 10001660 Enable Routers PIN Y To prevent PIN compromise auto disable the PIN after 3 failed PIN connections until router reboots In auto disabled mode router s WPS LED will keep blinking slowly V Keep Existing Wireless Settings V Enable BEAMFORMING The Router s PIN field displays the fixed PIN that you use to configure the modem router s WiFi settings from another platform through WPS To disable the PIN clear the Enable Router s PIN check box By default the Enable Router s PIN check box is selected and the modem router s PIN is enabled For enhanced security you can disable the modem router s PIN by clearing the Enable Router s PIN check box However when you disable the modem router s PIN WPS is not disabled because you can still use the physical WPS button Note The PIN function might temporarily be disabled automatically if the modem router detects suspicious attempts to break into the modem router s WiFi settings by using the router s PIN through WPS Manage the Advanced WiFi Features 249 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 7 To allow the WiFi settings to be changed automatically when you use WPS clear the Keep Existing Wireless Settings check box By default the Keep Existing Wireless Settings check box is se
328. ver to which the modem router forwards all other incoming protocols see Set Up a Default DMZ Server on page 202 Forward Incoming Traffic for a Default Service or Application You can forward traffic for a default service or application to a computer on your network To forward incoming traffic for a default service or application i 2 Decide which type of service application or game you want to provide Find the local IP address of the computer on your network that will provide the service The server computer must always receive the same IP address To specify this setting use the reserved IP address feature See Manage Reserved LAN IP Addresses on page 208 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Port Forwarding Port Triggering Port Forwarding Port Triggering Please select the service type Port Forwarding Port Triggering Service Name Server IP Address FTP 192 168 1 Add ServiceName External Start Port External End Port Internal Start Port internal End Port Internal IP address Edit Service x Delete Service Add Custom Service Make sure that the Port Forwarding radio b
329. vice or firewall Based on what your Internet service provider ISP requires for the device to connect to the ISP s Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 197 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 network directly you can enable the bridge between the device and the modem router s Internet port or add new VLAN tag groups to the bridge Noie If your ISP provides directions on how to set up a bridge for IPTV and Internet service follow those directions Set Up a Bridge for a Port Group If the devices that are connected to the modem router s Ethernet LAN port or WiFi network include an IPTV device your ISP might require you to set up a bridge for a port group for the modem router s Internet interface A bridge with a port group prevents packets that are sent between the IPTV device and the modem router s Internet port from being processed through the modem router s network address translation NAT service To configure a port group and enable the bridge i 2 Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt VLAN Bridge Settings The VLAN Bridge Settings page displays Select th
330. vider Select the encapsulation as indicated by your ISP e PPTP Your Internet connection uses Point to Point Tunneling Protocol L2TP Your Internet connection uses Layer Two Tunneling Protocol Login Enter the login name that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP This login name is often an email address Enter the password that you use to log in to your Internet service as indicated by your ISP Manage the Internet Settings Manually 78 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 a beea Connection Mode Select how the Internet connection functions e Always On Once the Internet connection is established it remains active This is the default setting Dial on Demand When someone attempts to connect to the Internet the Internet connection is established When the idle time out period expires the Internet connection is terminated Manually Connect You must connect to the Internet manually see View Establish or Terminate the PPTP or L2TP Internet Connection on page 233 Idle Timeout In Minutes If you select Dial on Demand from the Connection Mode menu enter the idle time out period in minutes The idle time out specifies how long the modem router keeps the Internet connection active when no one on the network is using the Internet connection The default is 5 minutes To disable the idle time out enter 0 When you disable the idle time out the connec
331. w this procedure To prepare to back up a large amount of data 1 Upgrade the operating system of the Mac computer 2 Verify and repair the backup disk and the local disk 3 Verify and repair the permissions on the local disk 4 Set Energy Saver a From the Apple menu select System Preferences The System Preferences page displays b Select Energy Saver The Energy Saver page displays Click the Power Adapter tab Select the Wake for Wi Fi network access check box e Click the back arrow to save the changes and exit the page 5 Modify your security settings a From the System Preferences page select Security amp Privacy The Security amp Privacy page displays b Click the Advanced button at the bottom of the page If the Advanced button is grayed out click the lock icon so that you can change the settings Clear the Log out after minutes of inactivity check box Click the OK button Your settings are saved Use Time Machine to Back Up Onto a Storage Device You can use Time Machine to back up your Mac computers onto a USB hard disk drive HDD that is connected to one of the modem router s USB ports or an eSATA storage device that is connected to the modem router s eSATA port Share a Storage Device 153 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To back up your Mac onto a USB HDD or eSATA storage device 1 Prepare your USB HDD or eSATA storage device with a compatibl
332. warning message before the monthly limit in hours is reached This setting is optional The modem router issues a warning when the balance falls under the number of minutes that you enter By default the value is 0 and no warning message is issued 10 Select one or more of the following actions to occur when the limit is reached Turn the Internet LED to flashing white amber This setting is optional When the traffic limit is reached the Internet LED alternates blinking white and amber Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 242 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 e Disconnect and disable the Internet connection This setting is optional When the traffic limit is reached the Internet connection is disconnected and disabled 11 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved and the modem router restarts The Internet Traffic Statistics section helps you to monitor the data traffic For more information see View the Internet Traffic Volume and Statistics on page 238 Unblock the Traffic Meter After the Traffic Limit Is Reached If you configured the traffic meter to disconnect and disable the Internet connection after the traffic limit is reached you cannot access the Internet until you unblock the traffic meter AN CAUTION If your ISP set a traffic limit your ISP might charge you for the overage traffic To unblock the traffic meter 1 Launch a web browser from a computer or Wi
333. west number in the range This IP address must be in the same subnet as the modem router By default the starting IP address is 192 168 1 2 In the Finish IP Address field enter the number at the end of the range of IP addresses This IP address must be in the same subnet as the modem router By default the ending IP address is 192 168 1 254 7 Click the Apply button Your settings are saved Manage Reserved LAN IP Addresses When you specify a reserved IP address for a computer on the LAN that computer always receives the same IP address each time it accesses the modem router s DHCP server Reserve a LAN IP Address You can assign a reserved IP address to a computer or server that requires permanent IP settings Manage the WAN and LAN Network Settings 208 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 To reserve an IP address Launch a web browser from a computer or WiFi device that is connected to the network Enter http www routerlogin net A login window opens Enter the modem router user name and password The user name is admin The default password is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Select ADVANCED gt Setup gt LAN Setup The LAN Setup page displays In the Address Reservation section click the Add button Either select a device from the Address Reservation Table by selecting the corresponding radio button or speci
334. word is password The user name and password are case sensitive The BASIC Home page displays Manage the Modem Router and Monitor the Traffic 241 Nighthawk X4S AC2600 WiFi VDSL ADSL Modem Router Model D7800 4 Select ADVANCED gt Advanced Setup gt Traffic Meter Traffic Meter Internet Traffic Meter C Enable Traffic Meter Traffic volume control by No limit Monthly limit 0 Mbytes Round up data volume for each connection by 0 Mbytes Connection time control Monthly limit 0 Hours Traffic Counter Restart traffic counter at 0 700 am Onthe ist day of each month Restart Counter Now Traffic Control Pop up a warning message 0 Mbytes Minutes before the monthly limit is reached When the monthly limit is reached Turn the Internet LED to flashing white amber Disconnect and disable the Internet connection Select the Enable Traffic Meter check box Select the Connection time control radio button Note The modem router must be connected to the Internet for you to be able to select the Connection time control radio bution 7 Inthe Monthly Limit field enter how many hours per month are allowed Note The modem router must be connected to the Internet for you to be able to enter information in the Monthly Limit field In the Traffic Counter section set the traffic counter to begin at a specific time and date In the Traffic Control section enter a value in minutes to specify when the modem router issues a
335. y Options None WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA WPA2 Enterprise Wireless Settings 5GHz 802 11a n ac Enable Guest Network v Enable SSID Broadcast Allow guests to see each other and access my local network Guest Wireless Network Name SSID NETGEAR 5G Guest Security Options None WPA2 PSK AES WPA PSK TKIP WPA2 PSK AES WPA WPA2 Enterprise 5 Enable the guest network and configure its WiFi settings as described in the following table ota pesermon ee s i siOY Wireless Network 2 4GHz b g n Enable Guest Network By default the guest WiFi network is disabled To enable the guest WiFi network for the 2 4 GHz WiFi band select the Enable Guest Network check box Enable SSID Broadcast By default the modem router broadcasts its SSID of the 2 4 GHz WiFi band so that WiFi stations can detect the WiFi name SSID in their scanned network lists To turn off the SSID broadcast for the 2 4 GHz WiFi band for the guest WiFi network clear the Enable SSID Broadcast check box Allow guests to see each By default WiFi clients that are connected to the 2 4 GHz WiFi band of the guest WiFi network other and access my local cannot access WiFi devices or Ethernet devices that are connected to the main WiFi network network To allow access to the main WiFi network select the Allow guests to see each other and access my local network check box Guest Wireless Network The SSID is the 2 4 GHz WiFi band

Download Pdf Manuals

image

Related Search

Related Contents

Magnavox MDR535H/F7 digital video recorder  11. colour true - calibration - colormunki  Configuração de monitoramento  0935 v1.1 Proseek Multiplex User Manual - final  ENE.2011 - Muebles Lluesma  Siemens SL56 User's Manual    User Manual_SRD-852D, 1652D_ITALIAN_Web.indb  Philips VR200/58 User's Manual  Consulte manual do fabricante.  

Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file